(while-no-input): Don't splice BODY directly into the `or' form.
[emacs.git] / man / texinfo.tex
blobf7bab248026ab6f15f88173304e85d6dc22b1b9a
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2007-06-24.23}
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
15 % your option) any later version.
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
24 % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
25 % Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
27 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
28 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
29 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
34 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
35 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % texindex foo.??
48 % tex foo.texi
49 % tex foo.texi
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
62 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
71 \chardef\other=12
73 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
74 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
75 \let\+ = \relax
77 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
78 \let\ptexb=\b
79 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
80 \let\ptexc=\c
81 \let\ptexcomma=\,
82 \let\ptexdot=\.
83 \let\ptexdots=\dots
84 \let\ptexend=\end
85 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
86 \let\ptexexclam=\!
87 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
88 \let\ptexgtr=>
89 \let\ptexhat=^
90 \let\ptexi=\i
91 \let\ptexindent=\indent
92 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
93 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
94 \let\ptexless=<
95 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
96 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
97 \let\ptexplus=+
98 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
99 \let\ptexslash=\/
100 \let\ptexstar=\*
101 \let\ptext=\t
103 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
104 % starts a new line in the output.
105 \newlinechar = `^^J
107 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
108 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
110 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
111 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
112 \else
113 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
116 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
117 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
118 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
156 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
157 \chardef\spacecat = 10
158 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
160 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
161 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
162 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
163 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
164 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
165 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
166 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
167 \chardef\questChar = `\?
168 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
169 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
170 \chardef\underChar = `\_
172 % Ignore a token.
174 \def\gobble#1{}
176 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
177 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
179 % Hyphenation fixes.
180 \hyphenation{
181 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
182 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
183 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
184 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
185 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
186 spell-ing spell-ings
187 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
188 wide-spread wrap-around
191 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
192 \newdimen\bindingoffset
193 \newdimen\normaloffset
194 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
196 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
197 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
198 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
200 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
202 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
203 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
204 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
205 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
206 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
208 \def\|{%
209 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
210 \leavevmode
212 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
213 \vadjust{%
214 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
215 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
216 \vskip-\baselineskip
218 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
219 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
220 \llap{%
222 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
223 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
225 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
226 \hskip 12pt
231 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
232 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
233 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
234 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
235 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
237 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
238 \def\loggingall{%
239 \tracingstats2
240 \tracingpages1
241 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
242 \tracingparagraphs1
243 \tracingoutput1
244 \tracingmacros2
245 \tracingrestores1
246 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
247 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
248 \tracingscantokens1
249 \tracingifs1
250 \tracinggroups1
251 \tracingnesting2
252 \tracingassigns1
254 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
255 \errorcontextlines16
258 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
259 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
261 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
262 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
263 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
264 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
265 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
266 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
268 % For @cropmarks command.
269 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
271 \newif\ifcropmarks
272 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
274 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
275 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
277 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
278 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
279 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
280 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
282 % Main output routine.
283 \chardef\PAGE = 255
284 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
286 \newbox\headlinebox
287 \newbox\footlinebox
289 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
290 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
291 \def\onepageout#1{%
292 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
294 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
295 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
297 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
298 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
299 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
300 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
303 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
304 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
305 % before the \shipout runs.
307 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
308 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
309 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
310 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
311 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
312 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
313 % it needs to be
314 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
315 \shipout\vbox{%
316 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
317 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
319 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
320 \hsize = \outerhsize
321 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
322 \vtop to0pt{%
323 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
324 \nointerlineskip
325 \line{%
326 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
327 \hfill
328 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
330 \vss}%
331 \vskip\topandbottommargin
332 \line\bgroup
333 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
334 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
335 \vbox\bgroup
338 \unvbox\headlinebox
339 \pagebody{#1}%
340 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
341 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
342 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
343 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
344 \vskip 24pt
345 \unvbox\footlinebox
348 \ifcropmarks
349 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
350 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
351 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
352 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
353 \vbox to0pt{\vss
354 \line{%
355 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
356 \hfill
357 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
359 \nointerlineskip
360 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
362 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
364 }% end of \shipout\vbox
365 }% end of group with \indexdummies
366 \advancepageno
367 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
370 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
372 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
373 {\catcode`\@ =11
374 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
375 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
376 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
377 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
378 \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
379 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
380 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
383 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
384 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
385 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
387 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
388 \def\nstop{\vbox
389 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
390 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
391 \def\nsbot{\vbox
392 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
394 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
395 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
396 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
398 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
399 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
400 \def\argtorun{#2}%
401 \begingroup
402 \obeylines
403 \spaceisspace
405 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
408 {\obeylines %
409 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
410 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
411 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
415 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
416 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
417 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
419 % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
421 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
422 % @end itemize @c foo
423 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
424 % by \finishparsearg.
426 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
427 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
428 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
429 \def\temp{#3}%
430 \ifx\temp\empty
431 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
432 \let\temp\finishparsearg
433 \else
434 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
436 % Put the space token in:
437 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
440 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
441 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
442 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
443 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
444 % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
445 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
446 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
448 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
450 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
452 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
453 % is roughly equivalent to
454 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
455 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
457 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
458 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
460 \def\parseargdef#1{%
461 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
463 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
464 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
465 \def#1##1%
468 % Several utility definitions with active space:
470 \obeyspaces
471 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
473 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
474 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
475 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
476 % should produce a line of output anyway.
478 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
480 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
481 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
482 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
483 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
487 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
489 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
491 % \envdef\foo{...}
492 % \def\Efoo{...}
494 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
495 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
496 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
497 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
498 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
500 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
501 % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
502 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
503 % special case.)
506 % At runtime, environments start with this:
507 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
508 % initialize
509 \let\thisenv\empty
511 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
512 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
513 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
515 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
516 \def\checkenv#1{%
517 \def\temp{#1}%
518 \ifx\thisenv\temp
519 \else
520 \badenverr
524 % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
525 \def\badenverr{%
526 \errhelp = \EMsimple
527 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
528 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
530 \def\inenvironment#1{%
531 \ifx#1\empty
532 out of any environment%
533 \else
534 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
538 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
539 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
541 \parseargdef\end{%
542 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
543 \else
544 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
545 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
546 \csname E#1\endcsname
547 \endgroup
551 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
554 %% Simple single-character @ commands
556 % @@ prints an @
557 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
558 \def\@{{\tt\char64}}
560 % This is turned off because it was never documented
561 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
562 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
563 %% but suppressing ligatures.
564 %\def\`{{`}}
565 %\def\'{{'}}
567 % Used to generate quoted braces.
568 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
569 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
570 \let\{=\mylbrace
571 \let\}=\myrbrace
572 \begingroup
573 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
574 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
575 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
576 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
577 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
578 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
579 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
580 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
581 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
582 !endgroup
584 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
585 \let\comma = ,
587 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
588 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
589 \let\, = \c
590 \let\dotaccent = \.
591 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
592 \let\tieaccent = \t
593 \let\ubaraccent = \b
594 \let\udotaccent = \d
596 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
597 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
598 \def\questiondown{?`}
599 \def\exclamdown{!`}
600 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
601 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
603 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
604 \def\imacro{i}
605 \def\jmacro{j}
606 \def\dotless#1{%
607 \def\temp{#1}%
608 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
609 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
610 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
611 \fi\fi
614 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
615 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
617 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
619 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
620 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
621 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
622 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
623 % \scriptscriptstyle).
625 \def\LaTeX{%
626 L\kern-.36em
627 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
628 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
629 \kern-.15em
630 \TeX
633 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
634 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
635 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
636 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
637 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
638 {\catcode`@ = 11
639 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
640 % if the definition is written into an index file.
641 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
642 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
645 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
646 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
648 % @* forces a line break.
649 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
651 % @/ allows a line break.
652 \let\/=\allowbreak
654 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
655 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
657 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
658 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
660 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
661 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
663 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
665 \def\onword{on}
666 \def\offword{off}
668 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
669 \def\temp{#1}%
670 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
671 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
672 \else
673 \errhelp = \EMsimple
674 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
675 \fi\fi
678 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
679 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
680 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
681 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
683 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
684 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
685 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
686 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
687 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
688 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
689 % the text is small, which looks bad.
691 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
692 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
693 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
694 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
695 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
696 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
698 \newbox\groupbox
699 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
701 \envdef\group{%
702 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
703 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
704 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
706 \startsavinginserts
708 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
709 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
710 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
711 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
712 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
713 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
714 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
715 \comment
718 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
719 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
720 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
721 % above. But it's pretty close.
722 \def\Egroup{%
723 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
724 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
725 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
726 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
727 \egroup % End the \vtop.
728 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
729 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
730 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
731 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
732 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
733 % group, force a page break.
734 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
735 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
736 \page
739 \box\groupbox
740 \prevdepth = \dimen1
741 \checkinserts
744 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
745 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
747 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
748 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
749 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
751 % @need space-in-mils
752 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
754 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
756 % Old definition--didn't work.
757 %\parseargdef\need{\par %
758 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
759 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
760 %{\baselineskip=0pt%
761 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
762 %\prevdepth=-1000pt
765 \parseargdef\need{%
766 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
767 % paragraph.
768 \par
770 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
771 \dimen0 = #1\mil
772 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
773 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
774 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
776 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
777 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
778 % And a page break here is fine.
779 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
781 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
782 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
783 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
784 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
785 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
787 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
788 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
789 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
790 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
791 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
792 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
793 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
794 \penalty9999
796 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
797 \kern -#1\mil
799 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
800 \nobreak
804 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
806 \let\br = \par
808 % @page forces the start of a new page.
810 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
812 % @exdent text....
813 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
815 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
816 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
817 \newskip\exdentamount
819 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
820 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
822 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
823 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
824 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
826 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
827 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
828 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
830 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
831 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
833 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
834 \nobreak
835 \kern-\strutdepth
836 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
837 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
838 \vss
839 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
840 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
841 \ifx#1l%
842 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
843 \else
844 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
846 \null
849 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
850 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
852 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
853 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
854 % else use TEXT for both).
856 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
857 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
858 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
859 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
860 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
861 \def\righttext{#2}%
862 \else
863 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
864 \def\righttext{#1}%
867 \ifodd\pageno
868 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
869 \else
870 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
872 \temp
875 % @include file insert text of that file as input.
877 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
878 \def\includezzz#1{%
879 \pushthisfilestack
880 \def\thisfile{#1}%
882 \makevalueexpandable
883 \def\temp{\input #1 }%
884 \expandafter
885 }\temp
886 \popthisfilestack
888 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
889 \catcode`\\=\other
890 \catcode`~=\other
891 \catcode`^=\other
892 \catcode`_=\other
893 \catcode`|=\other
894 \catcode`<=\other
895 \catcode`>=\other
896 \catcode`+=\other
897 \catcode`-=\other
900 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
901 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
903 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
904 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
906 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
907 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
910 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
911 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
912 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
914 \def\thisfile{}
916 % @center line
917 % outputs that line, centered.
919 \parseargdef\center{%
920 \ifhmode
921 \let\next\centerH
922 \else
923 \let\next\centerV
925 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
927 \def\centerH#1{%
929 \hfil\break
930 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
931 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
932 \line{#1}%
933 \break
936 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
938 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
940 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
942 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
943 % @c is the same as @comment
944 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
946 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
947 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
948 \commentxxx}
949 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
951 \let\c=\comment
953 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
954 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
955 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
956 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
958 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
959 \def\noneword{none}
961 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
962 \def\temp{#1}%
963 \ifx\temp\asisword
964 \else
965 \ifx\temp\noneword
966 \defaultparindent = 0pt
967 \else
968 \defaultparindent = #1em
971 \parindent = \defaultparindent
974 % @exampleindent NCHARS
975 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
976 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
977 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
978 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
979 \def\temp{#1}%
980 \ifx\temp\asisword
981 \else
982 \ifx\temp\noneword
983 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
984 \else
985 \lispnarrowing = #1em
990 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
991 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
992 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
993 % paragraphs.
995 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
996 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
997 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
998 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1000 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1001 \def\insertword{insert}
1003 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1004 \def\temp{#1}%
1005 \ifx\temp\noneword
1006 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1007 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1008 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1009 \else
1010 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1011 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1012 \fi\fi
1015 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1016 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1018 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1019 % paragraph.
1021 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1022 \gdef\indent{%
1023 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1024 \indent
1026 \gdef\noindent{%
1027 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1028 \noindent
1030 \global\everypar = {%
1031 \kern -\parindent
1032 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1036 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1037 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
1038 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
1039 \global \everypar = {}%
1043 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
1045 \def\asis#1{#1}
1047 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
1049 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
1050 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
1051 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
1052 % which is what @var uses.
1054 \catcode`\_ = \active
1055 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
1056 \catcode`\_=\active
1057 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
1060 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
1061 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
1062 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
1063 % otherwise define @\.
1065 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
1066 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
1068 \def\math{%
1069 \tex
1070 \mathunderscore
1071 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
1072 \mathactive
1073 $\finishmath
1075 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
1077 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
1078 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
1079 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
1082 \catcode`^ = \active
1083 \catcode`< = \active
1084 \catcode`> = \active
1085 \catcode`+ = \active
1086 \gdef\mathactive{%
1087 \let^ = \ptexhat
1088 \let< = \ptexless
1089 \let> = \ptexgtr
1090 \let+ = \ptexplus
1094 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
1095 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
1096 \def\minus{$-$}
1098 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
1099 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
1100 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
1101 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
1102 % whichever is larger.
1104 \def\dots{%
1105 \leavevmode
1106 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
1107 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
1108 \dimen0 = \wd0
1109 \else
1110 \dimen0 = 1.5em
1112 \hbox to \dimen0{%
1113 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
1114 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1115 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1116 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
1120 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
1122 \def\enddots{%
1123 \dots
1124 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
1127 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
1128 % Texinfo's parsing.
1130 \let\comma = ,
1132 % @refill is a no-op.
1133 \let\refill=\relax
1135 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1136 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1137 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1139 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1140 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
1142 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1143 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1144 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1145 \def\setfilename{%
1146 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1147 \iflinks
1148 \tryauxfile
1149 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1150 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
1151 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1152 \openindices
1153 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1155 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1156 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1157 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1158 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
1159 \closein 1
1161 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1164 % Called from \setfilename.
1166 \def\openindices{%
1167 \newindex{cp}%
1168 \newcodeindex{fn}%
1169 \newcodeindex{vr}%
1170 \newcodeindex{tp}%
1171 \newcodeindex{ky}%
1172 \newcodeindex{pg}%
1175 % @bye.
1176 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1179 \message{pdf,}
1180 % adobe `portable' document format
1181 \newcount\tempnum
1182 \newcount\lnkcount
1183 \newtoks\filename
1184 \newcount\filenamelength
1185 \newcount\pgn
1186 \newtoks\toksA
1187 \newtoks\toksB
1188 \newtoks\toksC
1189 \newtoks\toksD
1190 \newbox\boxA
1191 \newcount\countA
1192 \newif\ifpdf
1193 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1195 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1196 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
1197 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
1198 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
1199 \else
1200 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1201 \else
1202 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1203 \else
1204 \pdftrue
1209 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1210 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1211 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1212 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1213 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
1214 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
1215 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1216 % that's what we do).
1218 % double active backslashes.
1220 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
1221 @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
1222 @catcode`@\=@active
1223 @let\=@doublebackslash}
1226 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
1227 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
1228 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
1229 % changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
1230 % from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
1232 % #1 is the tokens to replace.
1233 % #2 is the replacement.
1234 % #3 is the control sequence with the string.
1236 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
1237 \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
1238 ##1%
1239 \ifx\\##2\\%
1240 \else
1242 \HyReturnAfterFi{%
1243 \HyPsdReplace##2\END
1247 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
1249 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
1251 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
1252 \def\backslashparens#1{%
1253 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
1254 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
1255 \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
1256 \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
1259 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1260 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1261 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1262 output) for that.)}
1264 \ifpdf
1265 \input pdfcolor
1266 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1268 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1269 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1270 \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1271 \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1273 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
1274 % others). Let's try in that order.
1275 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1276 \begingroup
1277 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1278 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1279 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1280 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1281 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1282 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1283 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1284 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1286 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1288 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1290 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1292 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1294 \closein 1
1295 \endgroup
1297 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1298 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1299 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1300 \immediate\pdfimage
1301 \else
1302 \immediate\pdfximage
1304 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
1305 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
1306 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1307 #1.\pdfimgext
1308 \else
1309 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1311 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1312 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1313 \fi}
1315 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
1316 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1317 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1318 \indexnofonts
1319 \turnoffactive
1320 \activebackslashdouble
1321 \makevalueexpandable
1322 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1323 \backslashparens\pdfdestname
1324 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1327 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1328 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1330 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
1331 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
1332 % (Defined in pdfcolor.tex.)
1333 \let\urlcolor = \BrickRed
1334 \let\linkcolor = \BrickRed
1335 \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
1337 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1338 % come from Petr Olsak
1339 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1340 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1341 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1342 \advance\tempnum by 1
1343 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1345 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1346 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1347 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1348 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1349 % #4 is the page number
1351 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1352 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1353 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1354 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1355 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1356 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1357 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1358 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1359 \else
1360 % Doubled backslashes in the name.
1361 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1362 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
1365 % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
1366 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1367 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
1369 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1372 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1373 \begingroup
1374 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
1375 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
1376 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
1378 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1379 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1380 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1381 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1382 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1384 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1385 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1386 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1387 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1389 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1390 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1391 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1393 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1394 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1396 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1397 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1398 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1400 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1401 % al. a second time, below.
1402 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1403 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1404 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1405 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1406 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1407 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1408 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1409 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1410 \readdatafile{toc}%
1412 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1413 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1414 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1416 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1417 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1418 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1419 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1420 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1421 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1422 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1423 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1424 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1426 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1427 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1428 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1429 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1430 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1432 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1433 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
1434 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
1435 \indexnofonts
1436 \setupdatafile
1437 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1438 \input \tocreadfilename
1439 \endgroup
1442 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1443 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1444 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1445 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1446 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1449 \nextsp}
1450 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
1451 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1452 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1453 \else
1454 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1456 % make a live url in pdf output.
1457 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1458 \begingroup
1459 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1460 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1461 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1462 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1464 \normalturnoffactive
1465 \def\@{@}%
1466 \let\/=\empty
1467 \makevalueexpandable
1468 \leavevmode\urlcolor
1469 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1470 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1471 \endgroup}
1472 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1473 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1474 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1475 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1476 \def\maketoks{%
1477 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1478 \ifx\first0\adn0
1479 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1480 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1481 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1482 \else
1483 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1484 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1485 \let\next=\maketoks
1486 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1487 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1489 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1490 \next}
1491 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1492 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1493 \def\pdflink#1{%
1494 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1495 \linkcolor #1\endlink}
1496 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1497 \else
1498 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1499 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1500 \let\endlink = \relax
1501 \let\linkcolor = \relax
1502 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1503 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1506 \message{fonts,}
1508 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1509 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1510 % italics, not bold italics.
1512 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1513 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1514 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
1517 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1519 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1521 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
1522 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
1523 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
1524 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
1525 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
1527 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1528 % So we set up a \sf.
1529 \newfam\sffam
1530 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
1531 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1533 % We don't need math for this font style.
1534 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
1537 % Default leading.
1538 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
1540 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1541 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1542 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1544 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1545 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1546 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1548 \def\setleading#1{%
1549 \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
1550 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1551 \normalbaselines
1552 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1553 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1554 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1559 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1561 % \cmapOT1
1562 \ifpdf
1563 \begingroup
1564 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1565 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1566 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1567 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1568 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1569 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1570 %%Version: 1.000
1571 %%EndComments
1572 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1573 12 dict begin
1574 begincmap
1575 /CIDSystemInfo
1576 << /Registry (TeX)
1577 /Ordering (OT1)
1578 /Supplement 0
1579 >> def
1580 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1581 /CMapType 2 def
1582 1 begincodespacerange
1583 <00> <7F>
1584 endcodespacerange
1585 8 beginbfrange
1586 <00> <01> <0393>
1587 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1588 <23> <26> <0023>
1589 <28> <3B> <0028>
1590 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1591 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1592 <61> <7A> <0061>
1593 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1594 endbfrange
1595 40 beginbfchar
1596 <02> <0398>
1597 <03> <039B>
1598 <04> <039E>
1599 <05> <03A0>
1600 <06> <03A3>
1601 <07> <03D2>
1602 <08> <03A6>
1603 <0B> <00660066>
1604 <0C> <00660069>
1605 <0D> <0066006C>
1606 <0E> <006600660069>
1607 <0F> <00660066006C>
1608 <10> <0131>
1609 <11> <0237>
1610 <12> <0060>
1611 <13> <00B4>
1612 <14> <02C7>
1613 <15> <02D8>
1614 <16> <00AF>
1615 <17> <02DA>
1616 <18> <00B8>
1617 <19> <00DF>
1618 <1A> <00E6>
1619 <1B> <0153>
1620 <1C> <00F8>
1621 <1D> <00C6>
1622 <1E> <0152>
1623 <1F> <00D8>
1624 <21> <0021>
1625 <22> <201D>
1626 <27> <2019>
1627 <3C> <00A1>
1628 <3D> <003D>
1629 <3E> <00BF>
1630 <5C> <201C>
1631 <5F> <02D9>
1632 <60> <2018>
1633 <7D> <02DD>
1634 <7E> <007E>
1635 <7F> <00A8>
1636 endbfchar
1637 endcmap
1638 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1641 %%EndResource
1642 %%EOF
1643 }\endgroup
1644 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1645 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1648 % \cmapOT1IT
1649 \begingroup
1650 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1651 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1652 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1653 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1654 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1655 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1656 %%Version: 1.000
1657 %%EndComments
1658 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1659 12 dict begin
1660 begincmap
1661 /CIDSystemInfo
1662 << /Registry (TeX)
1663 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1664 /Supplement 0
1665 >> def
1666 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1667 /CMapType 2 def
1668 1 begincodespacerange
1669 <00> <7F>
1670 endcodespacerange
1671 8 beginbfrange
1672 <00> <01> <0393>
1673 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1674 <25> <26> <0025>
1675 <28> <3B> <0028>
1676 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1677 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1678 <61> <7A> <0061>
1679 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1680 endbfrange
1681 42 beginbfchar
1682 <02> <0398>
1683 <03> <039B>
1684 <04> <039E>
1685 <05> <03A0>
1686 <06> <03A3>
1687 <07> <03D2>
1688 <08> <03A6>
1689 <0B> <00660066>
1690 <0C> <00660069>
1691 <0D> <0066006C>
1692 <0E> <006600660069>
1693 <0F> <00660066006C>
1694 <10> <0131>
1695 <11> <0237>
1696 <12> <0060>
1697 <13> <00B4>
1698 <14> <02C7>
1699 <15> <02D8>
1700 <16> <00AF>
1701 <17> <02DA>
1702 <18> <00B8>
1703 <19> <00DF>
1704 <1A> <00E6>
1705 <1B> <0153>
1706 <1C> <00F8>
1707 <1D> <00C6>
1708 <1E> <0152>
1709 <1F> <00D8>
1710 <21> <0021>
1711 <22> <201D>
1712 <23> <0023>
1713 <24> <00A3>
1714 <27> <2019>
1715 <3C> <00A1>
1716 <3D> <003D>
1717 <3E> <00BF>
1718 <5C> <201C>
1719 <5F> <02D9>
1720 <60> <2018>
1721 <7D> <02DD>
1722 <7E> <007E>
1723 <7F> <00A8>
1724 endbfchar
1725 endcmap
1726 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1729 %%EndResource
1730 %%EOF
1731 }\endgroup
1732 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
1733 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1736 % \cmapOT1TT
1737 \begingroup
1738 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1739 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1740 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1741 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1742 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1743 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1744 %%Version: 1.000
1745 %%EndComments
1746 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1747 12 dict begin
1748 begincmap
1749 /CIDSystemInfo
1750 << /Registry (TeX)
1751 /Ordering (OT1TT)
1752 /Supplement 0
1753 >> def
1754 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
1755 /CMapType 2 def
1756 1 begincodespacerange
1757 <00> <7F>
1758 endcodespacerange
1759 5 beginbfrange
1760 <00> <01> <0393>
1761 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1762 <21> <26> <0021>
1763 <28> <5F> <0028>
1764 <61> <7E> <0061>
1765 endbfrange
1766 32 beginbfchar
1767 <02> <0398>
1768 <03> <039B>
1769 <04> <039E>
1770 <05> <03A0>
1771 <06> <03A3>
1772 <07> <03D2>
1773 <08> <03A6>
1774 <0B> <2191>
1775 <0C> <2193>
1776 <0D> <0027>
1777 <0E> <00A1>
1778 <0F> <00BF>
1779 <10> <0131>
1780 <11> <0237>
1781 <12> <0060>
1782 <13> <00B4>
1783 <14> <02C7>
1784 <15> <02D8>
1785 <16> <00AF>
1786 <17> <02DA>
1787 <18> <00B8>
1788 <19> <00DF>
1789 <1A> <00E6>
1790 <1B> <0153>
1791 <1C> <00F8>
1792 <1D> <00C6>
1793 <1E> <0152>
1794 <1F> <00D8>
1795 <20> <2423>
1796 <27> <2019>
1797 <60> <2018>
1798 <7F> <00A8>
1799 endbfchar
1800 endcmap
1801 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1804 %%EndResource
1805 %%EOF
1806 }\endgroup
1807 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
1808 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1810 \else
1811 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1812 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1813 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1817 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1818 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1819 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1820 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
1821 % empty to omit).
1822 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1823 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
1824 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
1826 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1827 \let\cmap\gobble
1830 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1831 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1832 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1833 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
1834 \def\fontprefix{cm}
1836 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1837 \def\rmshape{r}
1838 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
1839 \def\bfshape{b}
1840 \def\bxshape{bx}
1841 \def\ttshape{tt}
1842 \def\ttbshape{tt}
1843 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
1844 \def\itshape{ti}
1845 \def\itbshape{bxti}
1846 \def\slshape{sl}
1847 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
1848 \def\sfshape{ss}
1849 \def\sfbshape{ss}
1850 \def\scshape{csc}
1851 \def\scbshape{csc}
1853 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
1854 % Texinfo.
1856 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1857 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1858 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
1859 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1860 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1861 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1862 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1863 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1864 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1865 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1866 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1867 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1868 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1869 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1871 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1872 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1873 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1874 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1875 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1877 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1878 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1879 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1880 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
1881 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1882 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
1883 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1884 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1885 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1886 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
1887 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1888 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1890 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1891 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1892 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1893 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
1894 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1895 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
1896 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1897 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1898 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1899 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
1900 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1901 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1903 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1904 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1905 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1906 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
1907 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1908 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1909 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
1910 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1911 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
1912 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1913 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
1914 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
1915 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
1916 \def\authortt{\sectt}
1918 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1919 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
1920 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1921 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
1922 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1923 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
1924 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1925 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
1926 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
1927 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1928 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
1929 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
1931 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1932 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
1933 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1934 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
1935 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1936 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1937 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
1938 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1939 \let\secbf\secrm
1940 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1941 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
1942 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
1944 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1945 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
1946 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1947 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
1948 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
1949 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1950 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
1951 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1952 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
1953 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
1954 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
1955 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
1957 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1958 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
1959 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1960 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
1961 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1962 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
1963 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1964 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1965 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1966 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
1967 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1968 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1970 % reset the current fonts
1971 \textfonts
1973 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions
1976 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
1977 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
1978 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
1979 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
1981 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
1982 % Text fonts (10pt).
1983 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
1984 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
1985 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1986 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1987 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1988 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1989 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1990 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1991 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1992 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1993 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1994 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1996 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1997 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1998 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1999 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2000 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
2002 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2003 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2004 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2005 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2006 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2007 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2008 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2009 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2010 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2011 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2012 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2013 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2015 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2016 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2017 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2018 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2019 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2020 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2021 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2022 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2023 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2024 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2025 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2026 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2028 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2029 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2030 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2031 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2032 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2033 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2034 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2035 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2036 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2037 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2038 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2039 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2040 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
2041 \def\authortt{\sectt}
2043 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2044 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2045 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2046 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2047 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2048 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2049 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2050 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2051 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2052 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2053 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2054 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2056 % Section fonts (12pt).
2057 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2058 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2059 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2060 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2061 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2062 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2063 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2064 \let\secbf\secrm
2065 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2066 \font\seci=cmmi12
2067 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2069 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2070 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2071 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2072 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2073 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2074 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2075 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2076 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2077 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2078 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2079 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2080 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2082 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2083 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2084 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2085 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2086 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2087 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2088 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2089 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2090 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2091 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2092 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2093 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2095 % reduce space between paragraphs
2096 \divide\parskip by 2
2098 % reset the current fonts
2099 \textfonts
2101 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions
2104 % We provide the user-level command
2105 % @fonttextsize 10
2106 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2108 \def\xword{10}
2109 \def\xiword{11}
2111 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2112 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2113 \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2115 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2116 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2118 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2119 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2120 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2121 \else
2122 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2123 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2124 \fi\fi
2125 \endgroup
2129 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2130 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2131 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2132 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2133 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2135 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2136 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
2137 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
2138 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
2141 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2142 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2143 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2144 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2146 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2147 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2148 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2150 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2152 \def\textfonts{%
2153 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
2154 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
2155 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
2156 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
2157 \def\curfontsize{text}%
2158 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2159 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2160 \def\titlefonts{%
2161 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
2162 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
2163 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
2164 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
2165 \def\curfontsize{title}%
2166 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
2167 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
2168 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2169 \def\chapfonts{%
2170 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
2171 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
2172 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
2173 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
2174 \def\curfontsize{chap}%
2175 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
2176 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
2177 \def\secfonts{%
2178 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
2179 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
2180 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
2181 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
2182 \def\curfontsize{sec}%
2183 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
2184 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
2185 \def\subsecfonts{%
2186 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
2187 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
2188 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
2189 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
2190 \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
2191 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
2192 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
2193 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
2194 \def\reducedfonts{%
2195 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
2196 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
2197 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
2198 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
2199 \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
2200 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2201 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2202 \def\smallfonts{%
2203 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
2204 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
2205 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
2206 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
2207 \def\curfontsize{small}%
2208 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2209 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2210 \def\smallerfonts{%
2211 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
2212 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
2213 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
2214 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
2215 \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
2216 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2217 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
2219 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2220 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2222 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2223 % can fit this many characters:
2224 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2225 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2226 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2227 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2228 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2230 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2231 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2233 % I wish the USA used A4 paper.
2234 % --karl, 24jan03.
2237 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2239 \definetextfontsizexi
2241 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2242 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2243 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2245 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2246 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2248 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2249 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2250 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2251 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2252 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2254 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
2255 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
2257 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
2258 % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
2259 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
2260 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
2261 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2262 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2264 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
2265 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
2266 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2268 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2269 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2270 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2272 \let\i=\smartitalic
2273 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2274 \let\var=\smartslanted
2275 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2276 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2278 % @b, explicit bold.
2279 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2280 \let\strong=\b
2282 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2283 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2285 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2286 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2287 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2289 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2290 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2292 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2293 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2294 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2296 \catcode`@=11
2297 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2298 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2299 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2300 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2302 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2303 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2304 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2305 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2307 \catcode`@=\other
2308 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2310 \def\t#1{%
2311 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2312 \null
2314 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
2315 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2316 \font\keysy=cmsy9
2317 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2318 \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2319 \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2320 \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2321 \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2322 \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2323 \def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2324 % The old definition, with no lozenge:
2325 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2326 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2328 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
2329 \let\file=\samp
2330 \let\option=\samp
2332 % @code is a modification of @t,
2333 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
2334 \def\tclose#1{%
2336 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2337 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2339 % Switch to typewriter.
2342 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2343 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2345 % Turn off hyphenation.
2346 \nohyphenation
2348 \rawbackslash
2349 \plainfrenchspacing
2352 \null
2355 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2356 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2357 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2359 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2360 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2361 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2362 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
2363 % -- rms.
2365 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2366 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2368 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2369 \catcode\rquoteChar=\active \catcode\lquoteChar=\active
2370 \let'\codequoteright \let`\codequoteleft
2372 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2373 \ifallowcodebreaks
2374 \let-\codedash
2375 \let_\codeunder
2376 \else
2377 \let-\realdash
2378 \let_\realunder
2380 \codex
2384 \def\realdash{-}
2385 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
2386 \def\codeunder{%
2387 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2388 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2389 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2390 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2391 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2392 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2393 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2394 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2395 {\_}%
2397 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2399 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2400 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
2401 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
2402 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
2404 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2406 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2407 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2409 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2410 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2411 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2412 \allowcodebreakstrue
2413 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2414 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2415 \else
2416 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2417 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
2418 \fi\fi
2421 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2422 % then @kbd has no effect.
2424 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2425 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2426 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2427 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2428 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2429 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2430 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2431 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2432 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2433 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2434 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2435 \else
2436 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2437 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
2438 \fi\fi\fi
2440 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
2441 \def\wordexample{example}
2442 \def\wordcode{code}
2444 % Default is `distinct.'
2445 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2447 \def\xkey{\key}
2448 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
2449 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2450 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
2451 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
2453 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
2454 \let\indicateurl=\code
2455 \let\env=\code
2456 \let\command=\code
2458 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
2459 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
2460 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
2461 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
2462 % a hypertex \special here.
2464 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
2465 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
2466 \unsepspaces
2467 \pdfurl{#1}%
2468 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2469 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2470 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2471 \else
2472 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2473 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2474 \ifpdf
2475 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2476 \else
2477 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2479 \else
2480 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
2483 \endlink
2484 \endgroup}
2486 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2488 \let\url=\uref
2490 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2491 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2493 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2494 \ifpdf
2495 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
2496 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
2497 \unsepspaces
2498 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
2499 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2500 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2501 \endlink
2502 \endgroup}
2503 \else
2504 \let\email=\uref
2507 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2508 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2509 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2510 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2512 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2514 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2515 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2517 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2519 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
2521 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2522 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2523 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2524 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2526 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2527 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2528 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2529 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2531 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2532 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2533 % all-uppercase.
2535 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
2536 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2537 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2538 \def\temp{#2}%
2539 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2540 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2544 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2545 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2547 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
2548 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2549 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2550 \def\temp{#2}%
2551 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2552 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2556 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
2558 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
2560 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
2561 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
2562 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
2563 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
2564 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
2566 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
2567 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
2568 % font height.
2570 % feymr - regular
2571 % feymo - slanted
2572 % feybr - bold
2573 % feybo - bold slanted
2575 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
2576 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
2577 % Hmm.
2579 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
2580 % Hope not.
2583 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
2584 \def\eurofont{%
2585 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
2586 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
2587 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
2588 % font installed.
2590 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
2591 % that to the current nominal size.
2593 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
2594 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
2596 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
2598 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2599 % bold:
2600 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
2601 \else
2602 % regular:
2603 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
2605 \thiseurofont
2608 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
2609 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
2610 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
2612 \def\registeredsymbol{%
2613 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
2614 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
2618 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
2620 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
2622 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
2623 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
2624 % so we'll define it if necessary.
2626 \ifx\Orb\undefined
2627 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
2631 \message{page headings,}
2633 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
2634 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
2636 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
2637 \newif\ifseenauthor
2638 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
2640 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
2641 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
2643 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2644 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2645 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2646 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2648 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
2649 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
2651 \envdef\titlepage{%
2652 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
2653 \begingroup
2654 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
2655 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
2656 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
2657 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
2658 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2660 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
2661 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
2662 \let\oldpage = \page
2663 \def\page{%
2664 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2665 \finishtitlepage
2667 \let\page = \oldpage
2668 \page
2669 \null
2673 \def\Etitlepage{%
2674 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2675 \finishtitlepage
2677 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
2678 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
2679 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
2680 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
2681 \oldpage
2682 \endgroup
2684 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
2685 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
2686 \HEADINGSon
2688 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
2689 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2690 \shortcontents
2691 \contents
2692 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
2693 \global\let\contents = \relax
2696 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2697 \contents
2698 \global\let\contents = \relax
2699 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
2703 \def\finishtitlepage{%
2704 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
2705 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
2706 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2709 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
2711 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
2712 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
2714 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
2715 \let\tt=\authortt}
2717 \parseargdef\title{%
2718 \checkenv\titlepage
2719 \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
2720 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
2721 \finishedtitlepagefalse
2722 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
2725 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
2726 \checkenv\titlepage
2727 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
2730 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
2731 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
2733 \parseargdef\author{%
2734 \def\temp{\quotation}%
2735 \ifx\thisenv\temp
2736 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
2737 \else
2738 \checkenv\titlepage
2739 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
2740 {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
2745 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
2747 \let\thispage=\folio
2749 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
2750 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
2751 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
2752 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
2754 % Now make TeX use those variables
2755 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
2756 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
2757 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
2758 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
2759 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
2761 % Commands to set those variables.
2762 % For example, this is what @headings on does
2763 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
2764 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
2765 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
2766 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
2769 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
2770 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2771 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2772 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2774 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
2775 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2776 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2777 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2779 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
2781 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
2782 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2783 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2784 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2786 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
2787 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2788 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2789 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
2791 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
2792 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
2793 \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
2794 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
2797 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
2800 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
2801 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
2802 % @headings off turns them off.
2803 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
2804 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2805 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2806 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
2807 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
2808 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
2810 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
2812 \def\HEADINGSoff{%
2813 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2814 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
2815 \HEADINGSoff
2816 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
2817 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
2818 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
2819 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
2820 % edge of all pages.
2821 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
2822 \global\pageno=1
2823 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2824 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2825 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2826 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2827 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
2829 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2831 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
2832 % page number on top right.
2833 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
2834 \global\pageno=1
2835 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2836 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2837 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2838 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2839 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2841 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
2843 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
2844 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
2845 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
2846 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2847 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2848 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2849 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2850 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
2853 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
2854 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
2855 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2856 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2857 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2858 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2859 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2862 % Subroutines used in generating headings
2863 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
2864 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
2865 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
2866 \ifx\today\undefined
2867 \def\today{%
2868 \number\day\space
2869 \ifcase\month
2870 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
2871 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
2872 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
2874 \space\number\year}
2877 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
2878 % It generates no output of its own.
2879 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
2880 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
2883 \message{tables,}
2884 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
2886 % default indentation of table text
2887 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
2888 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
2889 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
2890 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
2891 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
2893 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
2894 \newdimen\itemmax
2896 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
2897 % these defs.
2898 % They also define \itemindex
2899 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
2901 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
2903 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
2905 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
2906 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
2908 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
2909 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
2910 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
2911 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
2912 \itemindex{#1}%
2913 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
2915 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
2916 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
2917 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
2918 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
2919 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
2920 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
2922 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
2923 % but leave it ragged-right.
2924 \begingroup
2925 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
2926 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
2927 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
2928 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
2929 \endgroup
2931 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
2932 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
2933 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
2935 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
2936 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
2937 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
2938 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
2939 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
2940 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
2942 \penalty 10001
2943 \endgroup
2944 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
2945 \else
2946 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
2947 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
2948 \noindent
2949 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
2950 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
2951 % eventually be printed.
2952 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
2953 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
2954 \unhbox0
2955 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
2956 \endgroup
2957 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
2961 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
2962 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
2964 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
2965 \envdef\table{%
2966 \let\itemindex\gobble
2967 \tablecheck{table}%
2969 \envdef\ftable{%
2970 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
2971 \tablecheck{ftable}%
2973 \envdef\vtable{%
2974 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
2975 \tablecheck{vtable}%
2977 \def\tablecheck#1{%
2978 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
2979 \endgroup
2980 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
2981 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
2982 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
2983 \else
2984 \let\next\tablex
2986 \next
2988 \def\tablex#1{%
2989 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
2990 \parsearg\tabley
2992 \def\tabley#1{%
2994 \makevalueexpandable
2995 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
2996 \expandafter
2997 }\temp \endtablez
2999 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3000 \aboveenvbreak
3001 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
3002 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
3003 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
3004 \itemmax=\tableindent
3005 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
3006 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
3007 \exdentamount=\tableindent
3008 \parindent = 0pt
3009 \parskip = \smallskipamount
3010 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3011 \let\item = \internalBitem
3012 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
3014 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3015 \let\Eftable\Etable
3016 \let\Evtable\Etable
3017 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3018 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3020 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3022 \newcount \itemno
3024 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3026 \def\doitemize#1{%
3027 \aboveenvbreak
3028 \itemmax=\itemindent
3029 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
3030 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
3031 \exdentamount=\itemindent
3032 \parindent=0pt
3033 \parskip=\smallskipamount
3034 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3035 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3036 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3037 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3038 \let\item=\itemizeitem
3041 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3043 \def\itemizeitem{%
3044 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
3045 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3047 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3048 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3049 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3050 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3051 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3052 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3053 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3054 % that's the theory.
3055 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
3056 \noindent
3057 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3058 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3059 \flushcr
3062 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3063 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3065 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3067 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3068 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3069 % argument is the same as `1'.
3071 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3072 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3073 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3074 \def\thearg{#1}%
3075 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3077 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3078 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3079 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3080 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3081 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3082 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3083 \ifx\rest\empty
3084 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3085 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3086 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3087 % not equal to itself.
3088 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3090 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3091 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3093 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
3094 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3095 \else
3096 % It's a letter.
3097 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
3098 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3099 \else
3100 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3103 \else
3104 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3105 \numericenumerate
3109 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3110 % given in \thearg.
3112 \def\numericenumerate{%
3113 \itemno = \thearg
3114 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3117 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3118 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3119 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3120 \startenumeration{%
3121 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3122 \ifnum\itemno=0
3123 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3124 alphabet}%
3126 \char\lccode\itemno
3130 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3131 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3132 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3133 \startenumeration{%
3134 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3135 \ifnum\itemno=0
3136 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3137 alphabet}
3139 \char\uccode\itemno
3143 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3144 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3145 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3147 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3148 \advance\itemno by -1
3149 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
3152 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3153 % to @enumerate.
3155 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
3156 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
3157 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3158 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3161 % @multitable macros
3162 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3164 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3165 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3166 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3167 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3169 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3171 % To make preamble:
3173 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3174 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3175 % @item ...
3177 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3178 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3179 % columns as desired.
3182 % Or use a template:
3183 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3184 % @item ...
3185 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3187 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3188 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3189 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3190 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3192 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3193 % if they are.
3195 % Sample multitable:
3197 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3198 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3199 % @item
3200 % first col stuff
3201 % @tab
3202 % second col stuff
3203 % @tab
3204 % third col
3205 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3206 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3208 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3209 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3210 % @end multitable
3212 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3213 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3214 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3215 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3216 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3217 % to baseline.
3218 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3220 \newskip\multitableparskip
3221 \newskip\multitableparindent
3222 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3223 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3224 \multitableparskip=0pt
3225 \multitableparindent=6pt
3226 \multitablecolspace=12pt
3227 \multitablelinespace=0pt
3229 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3231 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3232 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3233 \let\columnfractions\relax
3234 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3235 \newif\ifsetpercent
3237 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3238 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3240 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3241 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3242 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3243 \setuptable
3246 \newcount\colcount
3247 \def\setuptable#1{%
3248 \def\firstarg{#1}%
3249 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3250 \let\go = \relax
3251 \else
3252 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3253 \global\setpercenttrue
3254 \else
3255 \ifsetpercent
3256 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3257 \else
3258 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3259 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3260 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3261 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3264 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3265 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3266 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3267 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3268 \else
3269 \let\go = \setuptable
3270 \fi%
3275 % multitable-only commands.
3277 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3278 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3279 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
3280 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
3282 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3283 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3284 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
3285 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3286 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
3288 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3290 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3292 \envdef\multitable{%
3293 \vskip\parskip
3294 \startsavinginserts
3296 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3297 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3298 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3299 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3300 \def\item{\crcr}%
3302 \tolerance=9500
3303 \hbadness=9500
3304 \setmultitablespacing
3305 \parskip=\multitableparskip
3306 \parindent=\multitableparindent
3307 \overfullrule=0pt
3308 \global\colcount=0
3310 \everycr = {%
3311 \noalign{%
3312 \global\everytab={}%
3313 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
3314 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3315 \checkinserts
3316 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3317 %\filbreak
3318 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3319 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3320 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3324 \parsearg\domultitable
3326 \def\domultitable#1{%
3327 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3328 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3330 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
3331 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
3332 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
3333 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
3334 \halign\bgroup &%
3335 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3336 \multistrut
3337 \vtop{%
3338 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
3339 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
3341 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
3342 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
3343 % the first one.
3345 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
3346 % to the width of each template entry.
3348 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
3349 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
3350 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
3351 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
3353 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
3354 \rightskip=0pt
3355 \ifnum\colcount=1
3356 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
3357 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
3358 \else
3359 \ifsetpercent \else
3360 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
3361 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
3362 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
3364 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
3365 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
3367 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
3368 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
3369 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
3370 % For example:
3371 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
3372 % @item @code{#}
3373 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
3374 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
3375 % marking characters.
3376 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
3377 }\cr
3379 \def\Emultitable{%
3380 \crcr
3381 \egroup % end the \halign
3382 \global\setpercentfalse
3385 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
3386 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
3388 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
3389 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
3390 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
3391 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
3392 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
3393 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
3394 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
3396 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
3397 %% table. If not, do nothing.
3398 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
3399 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
3400 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
3401 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3402 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3403 \fi%
3404 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
3405 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
3406 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3407 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3408 \fi}
3411 \message{conditionals,}
3413 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
3414 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
3415 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
3416 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
3417 % attempt to close an environment group.
3419 \def\makecond#1{%
3420 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
3421 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
3423 \makecond{iftex}
3424 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
3425 \makecond{ifnothtml}
3426 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
3427 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
3428 \makecond{ifnotxml}
3430 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
3432 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
3433 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
3434 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
3435 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
3436 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
3437 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
3438 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
3439 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
3440 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
3441 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
3442 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
3443 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
3444 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
3446 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
3448 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
3449 \newcount\doignorecount
3451 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
3452 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
3453 \obeylines
3454 \catcode`\@ = \other
3455 \catcode`\{ = \other
3456 \catcode`\} = \other
3458 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
3459 \spaceisspace
3461 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
3462 \doignorecount = 0
3464 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
3465 \dodoignore{#1}%
3468 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
3469 \obeylines %
3471 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
3472 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
3474 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
3475 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
3476 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
3478 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
3479 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
3480 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
3481 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
3483 % And now expand that command.
3484 \doignoretext ^^M%
3488 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
3489 \def\temp{#1}%
3490 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
3491 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
3492 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
3493 \advance\doignorecount by 1
3494 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
3495 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
3497 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
3500 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
3502 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
3503 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
3504 \let\next\enddoignore
3505 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
3506 \advance\doignorecount by -1
3507 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
3509 \next
3512 % Finish off ignored text.
3513 { \obeylines%
3514 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
3515 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
3516 % would result in a blank line in the output.
3517 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
3521 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
3522 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
3524 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
3525 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
3526 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
3527 % didn't need it.
3528 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
3530 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
3531 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
3533 \makevalueexpandable
3534 \def\temp{#2}%
3535 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
3536 \ifx\temp\empty
3537 \next{}%
3538 \else
3539 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
3543 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
3544 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
3546 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
3548 \parseargdef\clear{%
3550 \makevalueexpandable
3551 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
3555 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
3556 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
3557 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
3559 \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
3561 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
3562 \let\value = \expandablevalue
3563 % We don't want these characters active, ...
3564 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
3565 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
3566 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
3567 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
3568 \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
3572 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
3573 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
3574 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
3575 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
3576 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
3577 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
3578 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
3580 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
3581 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
3582 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
3583 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
3584 \else
3585 \csname SET#1\endcsname
3589 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
3590 % with @set.
3592 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
3594 \makecond{ifset}
3595 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
3596 \def\doifset#1#2{%
3598 \makevalueexpandable
3599 \let\next=\empty
3600 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
3601 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
3603 \expandafter
3604 }\next
3606 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
3608 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
3609 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
3611 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
3612 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
3613 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
3615 \makecond{ifclear}
3616 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
3617 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
3619 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
3620 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
3621 \let\dircategory=\comment
3623 % @defininfoenclose.
3624 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
3627 \message{indexing,}
3628 % Index generation facilities
3630 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
3631 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
3632 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
3634 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
3635 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
3636 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
3637 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
3638 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
3639 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
3640 % for the sake of vms.
3642 \def\newindex#1{%
3643 \iflinks
3644 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
3645 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
3647 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
3648 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
3651 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
3653 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
3655 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
3657 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
3659 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
3660 \iflinks
3661 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
3662 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
3664 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
3665 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
3669 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
3670 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
3672 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
3673 % inside @code.
3675 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
3676 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
3678 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
3679 % #3 the target index (bar).
3680 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
3681 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
3682 % closing the target index.
3683 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
3684 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
3685 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
3686 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
3687 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
3689 % redefine \fooindfile:
3690 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
3691 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
3692 % redefine \fooindex:
3693 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
3696 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
3697 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
3698 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
3700 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
3701 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
3703 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
3704 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
3706 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
3707 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
3709 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
3710 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
3711 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
3713 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
3714 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
3715 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
3717 \def\indexdummies{%
3718 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
3719 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
3720 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
3722 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
3723 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
3724 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
3725 \let\{ = \mylbrace
3726 \let\} = \myrbrace
3728 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
3729 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
3730 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
3731 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
3732 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
3733 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
3734 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
3735 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
3736 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
3738 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
3739 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
3740 % @macro funindex {WORD}
3741 % @findex xyz
3742 % @end macro
3743 % ...
3744 % @funindex commtest
3746 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
3748 % Sample whatsit resulting:
3749 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
3751 % So:
3752 \let\endinput = \empty
3754 % Do the redefinitions.
3755 \commondummies
3758 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
3759 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
3760 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
3761 % this will be simpler.
3763 \def\atdummies{%
3764 \def\@{@@}%
3765 \def\ {@ }%
3766 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
3767 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
3769 % Do the redefinitions.
3770 \commondummies
3771 \otherbackslash
3774 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
3776 \def\commondummies{%
3778 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
3779 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
3780 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
3781 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
3782 % from whatever follows.
3784 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
3785 % space.
3787 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
3788 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
3789 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
3791 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
3792 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
3793 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
3795 \commondummiesnofonts
3797 \definedummyletter\_%
3799 % Non-English letters.
3800 \definedummyword\AA
3801 \definedummyword\AE
3802 \definedummyword\L
3803 \definedummyword\OE
3804 \definedummyword\O
3805 \definedummyword\aa
3806 \definedummyword\ae
3807 \definedummyword\l
3808 \definedummyword\oe
3809 \definedummyword\o
3810 \definedummyword\ss
3811 \definedummyword\exclamdown
3812 \definedummyword\questiondown
3813 \definedummyword\ordf
3814 \definedummyword\ordm
3816 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
3817 \definedummyword\bf
3818 \definedummyword\gtr
3819 \definedummyword\hat
3820 \definedummyword\less
3821 \definedummyword\sf
3822 \definedummyword\sl
3823 \definedummyword\tclose
3824 \definedummyword\tt
3826 \definedummyword\LaTeX
3827 \definedummyword\TeX
3829 % Assorted special characters.
3830 \definedummyword\bullet
3831 \definedummyword\comma
3832 \definedummyword\copyright
3833 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
3834 \definedummyword\dots
3835 \definedummyword\enddots
3836 \definedummyword\equiv
3837 \definedummyword\error
3838 \definedummyword\euro
3839 \definedummyword\expansion
3840 \definedummyword\minus
3841 \definedummyword\pounds
3842 \definedummyword\point
3843 \definedummyword\print
3844 \definedummyword\result
3845 \definedummyword\textdegree
3847 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
3848 \macrolist
3850 \normalturnoffactive
3852 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
3853 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
3854 \makevalueexpandable
3857 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
3859 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
3860 % Control letters and accents.
3861 \definedummyletter\!%
3862 \definedummyaccent\"%
3863 \definedummyaccent\'%
3864 \definedummyletter\*%
3865 \definedummyaccent\,%
3866 \definedummyletter\.%
3867 \definedummyletter\/%
3868 \definedummyletter\:%
3869 \definedummyaccent\=%
3870 \definedummyletter\?%
3871 \definedummyaccent\^%
3872 \definedummyaccent\`%
3873 \definedummyaccent\~%
3874 \definedummyword\u
3875 \definedummyword\v
3876 \definedummyword\H
3877 \definedummyword\dotaccent
3878 \definedummyword\ringaccent
3879 \definedummyword\tieaccent
3880 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
3881 \definedummyword\udotaccent
3882 \definedummyword\dotless
3884 % Texinfo font commands.
3885 \definedummyword\b
3886 \definedummyword\i
3887 \definedummyword\r
3888 \definedummyword\sc
3889 \definedummyword\t
3891 % Commands that take arguments.
3892 \definedummyword\acronym
3893 \definedummyword\cite
3894 \definedummyword\code
3895 \definedummyword\command
3896 \definedummyword\dfn
3897 \definedummyword\emph
3898 \definedummyword\env
3899 \definedummyword\file
3900 \definedummyword\kbd
3901 \definedummyword\key
3902 \definedummyword\math
3903 \definedummyword\option
3904 \definedummyword\pxref
3905 \definedummyword\ref
3906 \definedummyword\samp
3907 \definedummyword\strong
3908 \definedummyword\tie
3909 \definedummyword\uref
3910 \definedummyword\url
3911 \definedummyword\var
3912 \definedummyword\verb
3913 \definedummyword\w
3914 \definedummyword\xref
3917 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
3918 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
3919 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
3920 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
3922 \def\indexnofonts{%
3923 % Accent commands should become @asis.
3924 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
3925 % We can just ignore other control letters.
3926 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
3927 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
3928 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
3930 \commondummiesnofonts
3932 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
3933 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
3934 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
3935 %\let\tt=\asis
3937 \def\ { }%
3938 \def\@{@}%
3939 % how to handle braces?
3940 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
3942 % Non-English letters.
3943 \def\AA{AA}%
3944 \def\AE{AE}%
3945 \def\L{L}%
3946 \def\OE{OE}%
3947 \def\O{O}%
3948 \def\aa{aa}%
3949 \def\ae{ae}%
3950 \def\l{l}%
3951 \def\oe{oe}%
3952 \def\o{o}%
3953 \def\ss{ss}%
3954 \def\exclamdown{!}%
3955 \def\questiondown{?}%
3956 \def\ordf{a}%
3957 \def\ordm{o}%
3959 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
3960 \def\TeX{TeX}%
3962 % Assorted special characters.
3963 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
3964 \def\bullet{bullet}%
3965 \def\comma{,}%
3966 \def\copyright{copyright}%
3967 \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
3968 \def\dots{...}%
3969 \def\enddots{...}%
3970 \def\equiv{==}%
3971 \def\error{error}%
3972 \def\euro{euro}%
3973 \def\expansion{==>}%
3974 \def\minus{-}%
3975 \def\pounds{pounds}%
3976 \def\point{.}%
3977 \def\print{-|}%
3978 \def\result{=>}%
3979 \def\textdegree{degrees}%
3981 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
3982 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
3983 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
3984 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
3985 % that starts with \.
3987 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
3988 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
3989 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
3991 \macrolist
3994 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
3995 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
3997 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
3998 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
3999 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4001 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4002 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4003 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4004 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4006 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4007 \iflinks
4009 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4010 \toks0 = {#2}%
4011 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4012 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
4013 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4014 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4017 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
4019 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4024 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4026 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4027 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4028 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4029 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
4032 % Remember, we are within a group.
4033 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4034 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4035 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4037 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4038 % get the string to sort by.
4039 {\indexnofonts
4040 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4041 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4044 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4045 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4046 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4047 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4048 % sorted result.
4049 \edef\temp{%
4050 \write\writeto{%
4051 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4053 \temp
4056 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4058 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4059 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4060 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4061 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4062 % sequences like this:
4063 % @end defun
4064 % @tindex whatever
4065 % @defun ...
4066 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4067 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4068 % the previous defun.
4070 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4071 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4073 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4075 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4076 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4077 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4078 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4079 % representation of the skip.
4081 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4082 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4084 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
4086 \newskip\whatsitskip
4087 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4089 % ..., ready, GO:
4091 \def\safewhatsit#1{%
4092 \ifhmode
4094 \else
4095 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4096 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
4097 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4098 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
4100 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4101 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4102 % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4103 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4104 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4105 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4106 \else
4107 \vskip-\whatsitskip
4112 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4113 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4114 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4115 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4116 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4117 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4119 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4120 % @vindex index-whatever
4121 % Description.
4122 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4123 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4124 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4125 \else
4126 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4127 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4128 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4129 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4134 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4135 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4136 % or
4137 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4138 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4139 % containing these kinds of lines:
4140 % \initial {c}
4141 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4142 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4143 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4144 % \primary {topic}
4145 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4146 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4147 % for each subtopic.
4149 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4150 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4152 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4153 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4154 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4155 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4156 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4157 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4159 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4160 {\obeylines %
4161 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
4162 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
4164 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4166 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4167 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4169 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4170 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4172 \smallfonts \rm
4173 \tolerance = 9500
4174 \plainfrenchspacing
4175 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4177 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4178 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4179 % \initial {@}
4180 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4181 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4182 \catcode`\@ = 11
4183 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
4184 \ifeof 1
4185 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4186 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4187 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4188 % there is some text.
4189 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4190 \else
4192 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4193 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4194 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4195 \read 1 to \temp
4196 \ifeof 1
4197 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4198 \else
4199 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4200 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4201 % to make right now.
4202 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4203 \catcode`\\ = 0
4204 \escapechar = `\\
4205 \begindoublecolumns
4206 \input \jobname.#1s
4207 \enddoublecolumns
4210 \closein 1
4211 \endgroup}
4213 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4214 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4216 \def\initial#1{{%
4217 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4218 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
4220 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
4221 \removelastskip
4223 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
4224 \nobreak
4225 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
4226 \penalty 0
4227 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
4229 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
4230 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
4231 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
4232 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
4234 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
4235 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
4236 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
4237 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
4238 \nobreak
4239 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
4242 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
4243 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
4244 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
4246 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
4247 % \def\entry#1#2{...
4248 % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
4249 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
4250 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
4252 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
4253 % --kasal, 21nov03
4254 \def\entry{%
4255 \begingroup
4257 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
4258 % affect previous text.
4259 \par
4261 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
4262 \parfillskip = 0in
4264 % No extra space above this paragraph.
4265 \parskip = 0in
4267 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
4268 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
4270 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
4271 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
4272 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
4273 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
4274 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
4276 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
4277 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
4278 \hangindent = 2em
4280 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
4281 % with blank space.
4282 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
4284 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
4285 % columns.
4286 \vskip 0pt plus1pt
4288 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
4289 \afterassignment\doentry
4290 \let\temp =
4292 \def\doentry{%
4293 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
4294 \noindent
4295 \aftergroup\finishentry
4296 % And now comes the text of the entry.
4298 \def\finishentry#1{%
4299 % #1 is the page number.
4301 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
4302 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
4303 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
4304 \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
4305 \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
4307 \else
4309 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
4310 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
4311 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
4312 \hfil\penalty50
4313 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
4315 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
4316 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
4317 % \hbox ensues.
4318 \ifpdf
4319 \pdfgettoks#1.%
4320 \ \the\toksA
4321 \else
4322 \ #1%
4325 \par
4326 \endgroup
4329 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
4330 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
4331 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
4333 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
4335 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
4336 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
4337 \parfillskip=0in
4338 \parskip=0in
4339 \hangindent=1in
4340 \hangafter=1
4341 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
4342 \ifpdf
4343 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
4344 \else
4347 \par
4350 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
4351 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
4352 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
4353 \catcode`\@=11
4355 \newbox\partialpage
4356 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
4358 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
4359 % Grab any single-column material above us.
4360 \output = {%
4362 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
4363 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
4364 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
4365 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
4366 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
4367 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
4368 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
4369 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
4370 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
4373 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
4374 % Unvbox the main output page.
4375 \unvbox\PAGE
4376 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
4379 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
4381 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
4382 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
4384 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
4385 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
4386 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
4387 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
4388 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
4390 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
4391 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
4392 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
4393 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
4394 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
4396 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
4397 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
4398 % been clobbered.
4400 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
4401 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
4402 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
4403 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
4405 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
4406 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
4407 \vsize = 2\vsize
4410 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
4411 % the last.
4413 \def\doublecolumnout{%
4414 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
4415 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
4416 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
4417 % previous page.
4418 \dimen@ = \vsize
4419 \divide\dimen@ by 2
4420 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
4422 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
4423 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
4424 \onepageout\pagesofar
4425 \unvbox255
4426 \penalty\outputpenalty
4429 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
4430 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
4431 \def\pagesofar{%
4432 \unvbox\partialpage
4434 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
4435 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
4436 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
4439 % All done with double columns.
4440 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
4441 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
4442 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
4443 % following situation:
4445 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
4446 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
4447 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
4448 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
4449 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
4450 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
4451 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
4452 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
4453 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
4454 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
4455 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
4456 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
4457 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
4458 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
4459 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
4460 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
4461 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
4462 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
4463 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
4465 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
4466 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
4467 \penalty0
4469 \output = {%
4470 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
4471 % current page, no automatic page break.
4472 \balancecolumns
4474 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
4475 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
4476 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
4477 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
4478 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
4479 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
4480 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
4481 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
4483 \eject
4484 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
4486 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
4487 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
4488 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
4489 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
4490 \pagegoal = \vsize
4493 % Called at the end of the double column material.
4494 \def\balancecolumns{%
4495 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
4496 \dimen@ = \ht0
4497 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
4498 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
4499 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
4500 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
4501 \splittopskip = \topskip
4502 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
4504 \vbadness = 10000
4505 \loop
4506 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
4507 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
4508 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
4509 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
4510 \repeat
4512 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
4513 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
4514 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
4516 \pagesofar
4518 \catcode`\@ = \other
4521 \message{sectioning,}
4522 % Chapters, sections, etc.
4524 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
4525 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
4526 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
4527 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
4528 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
4529 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
4530 \newcount\chapno
4531 \newcount\secno \secno=0
4532 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
4533 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
4535 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
4536 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
4538 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
4539 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
4540 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
4541 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
4543 \def\appendixletter{%
4544 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
4545 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
4546 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
4547 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
4548 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
4549 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
4550 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
4551 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
4552 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
4553 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
4554 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
4555 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
4556 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
4557 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
4558 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
4559 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
4560 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
4561 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
4562 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
4563 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
4564 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
4565 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
4566 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
4567 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
4568 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
4569 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
4570 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
4571 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
4572 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
4573 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
4574 \else\char\the\appendixno
4575 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
4576 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
4578 % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
4579 % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
4580 % However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
4581 \def\thischapter{}
4582 \def\thissection{}
4584 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
4585 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
4587 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
4588 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
4589 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
4591 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
4592 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
4593 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
4595 % we only have subsub.
4596 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
4598 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
4599 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
4600 \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
4602 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
4603 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
4604 \def\chapheadtype{N}
4606 % Choose a heading macro
4607 % #1 is heading type
4608 % #2 is heading level
4609 % #3 is text for heading
4610 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
4611 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
4612 \absseclevel=#2
4613 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
4614 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
4615 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
4616 \absseclevel = 0
4617 \else
4618 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
4619 \absseclevel = 3
4622 % The heading type:
4623 \def\headtype{#1}%
4624 \if \headtype U%
4625 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
4626 \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
4628 \else
4629 % Check for appendix sections:
4630 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
4631 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
4632 \else
4633 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
4634 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
4635 \fi\fi
4637 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
4638 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
4639 \def\headtype{U}%
4640 \else
4641 \chardef\unmlevel = 3
4644 % Now print the heading:
4645 \if \headtype U%
4646 \ifcase\absseclevel
4647 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
4648 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
4649 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4650 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4652 \else
4653 \if \headtype A%
4654 \ifcase\absseclevel
4655 \appendixzzz{#3}%
4656 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
4657 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
4658 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4660 \else
4661 \ifcase\absseclevel
4662 \chapterzzz{#3}%
4663 \or \seczzz{#3}%
4664 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4665 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4669 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4672 % an interface:
4673 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
4674 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
4675 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
4677 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
4678 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
4680 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
4681 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
4682 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
4684 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
4685 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
4686 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
4687 % as an @include file.
4688 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4689 \global\advance\chapno by 1
4691 % Used for \float.
4692 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
4693 \resetallfloatnos
4695 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
4697 % Write the actual heading.
4698 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
4700 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
4701 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
4702 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
4703 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
4706 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
4707 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
4708 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4709 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
4710 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
4711 \resetallfloatnos
4713 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
4714 \message{\appendixnum}%
4716 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
4718 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
4719 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
4720 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
4723 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
4724 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
4725 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4726 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
4728 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
4729 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
4730 \resetallfloatnos
4732 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
4733 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
4734 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
4735 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
4736 % to be executed, not expanded).
4738 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
4739 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
4740 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
4741 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
4742 % the toc entries.)
4743 \toks0 = {#1}%
4744 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
4746 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
4748 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
4749 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
4750 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
4753 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
4754 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
4755 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
4756 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
4757 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
4758 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
4759 \unnmhead0{#1}%
4760 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
4763 % @top is like @unnumbered.
4764 \let\top\unnumbered
4766 % Sections.
4767 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
4768 \def\seczzz#1{%
4769 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4770 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
4773 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
4774 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
4775 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4776 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
4778 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
4780 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
4781 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
4782 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4783 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
4786 % Subsections.
4787 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
4788 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
4789 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4790 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4793 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
4794 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
4795 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4796 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
4797 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4800 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
4801 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
4802 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4803 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
4804 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4807 % Subsubsections.
4808 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
4809 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4810 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4811 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
4812 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
4815 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
4816 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
4817 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4818 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
4819 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
4822 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
4823 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4824 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4825 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
4826 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
4829 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
4830 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
4831 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
4832 \let\section = \numberedsec
4833 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
4834 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
4836 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
4838 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
4839 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
4840 % overlong headings to fold.
4841 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
4842 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
4843 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
4844 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
4847 \def\majorheading{%
4848 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
4849 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
4852 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
4853 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
4854 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
4855 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
4856 \rm #1\hfill}}%
4857 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
4858 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4861 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
4862 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
4863 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4864 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
4865 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4866 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
4867 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4869 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
4870 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
4871 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
4873 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
4874 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
4876 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
4877 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
4879 \newskip\chapheadingskip
4881 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
4882 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
4883 \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
4885 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
4887 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
4888 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
4889 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
4890 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
4892 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
4893 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
4894 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
4895 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
4896 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
4898 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
4899 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
4900 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
4901 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
4902 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
4904 \CHAPPAGon
4906 % Chapter opening.
4908 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
4909 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
4911 % To test against our argument.
4912 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
4913 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
4914 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
4916 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
4917 \pchapsepmacro
4919 \chapfonts \rm
4921 % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
4922 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
4923 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
4924 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
4925 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
4927 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
4928 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
4929 \def\temptype{#2}%
4930 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
4931 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
4932 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
4933 \gdef\thischapternum{}%
4934 \gdef\thischapter{#1}%
4935 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
4936 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
4937 \def\toctype{omit}%
4938 \gdef\thischapternum{}%
4939 \gdef\thischapter{}%
4940 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
4941 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
4942 \def\toctype{app}%
4943 \xdef\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
4944 % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
4945 % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't
4946 % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
4948 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
4949 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
4950 \else
4951 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
4952 \def\toctype{numchap}%
4953 \xdef\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
4954 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
4955 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
4956 \fi\fi\fi
4958 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
4959 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
4960 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
4961 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
4963 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
4964 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
4965 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
4966 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
4967 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
4968 \donoderef{#2}%
4970 % Typeset the actual heading.
4971 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
4972 \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
4973 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
4975 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
4976 \nobreak
4979 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
4980 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
4981 \def\centerparameters{%
4982 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
4983 \leftskip = \rightskip
4984 \parfillskip = 0pt
4988 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
4989 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
4991 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
4993 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
4994 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
4995 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
4996 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
4998 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
4999 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5000 \par\penalty 5000 %
5002 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5003 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5004 \parindent=0pt
5005 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5007 \def\CHAPFopen{%
5008 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
5009 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
5012 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5013 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5015 \newskip\secheadingskip
5016 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
5018 % Subsection titles.
5019 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5020 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
5022 % Subsubsection titles.
5023 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5024 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5027 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5029 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5030 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5031 % section number.
5033 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5035 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5036 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
5038 % Insert space above the heading.
5039 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
5041 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5042 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5043 \def\temptype{#3}%
5045 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5046 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5047 \def\toctype{unn}%
5048 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
5049 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5050 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5051 % and don't redefine \thissection.
5052 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5053 \def\toctype{omit}%
5054 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
5055 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5056 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5057 \def\toctype{app}%
5058 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
5059 \else
5060 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5061 \def\toctype{num}%
5062 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
5063 \fi\fi\fi
5065 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5066 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5068 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5069 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5070 \donoderef{#3}%
5072 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5073 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5074 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5075 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5076 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5077 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5078 \nobreak
5080 % Output the actual section heading.
5081 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
5082 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
5083 \unhbox0 #1}%
5085 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5086 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5087 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
5089 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5090 % was followed by glue.
5091 \nobreak
5093 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
5094 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
5095 % discardable item.)
5096 \vskip-\parskip
5098 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
5099 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
5100 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
5102 % @section sec-whatever
5103 % @deffn def-whatever
5104 \penalty 10001
5108 \message{toc,}
5109 % Table of contents.
5110 \newwrite\tocfile
5112 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
5113 % Called from @chapter, etc.
5115 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
5116 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
5117 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
5118 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
5119 % destination to jump to.
5121 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
5122 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
5123 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
5124 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
5126 \newif\iftocfileopened
5127 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
5129 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
5130 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
5131 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
5132 \iftocfileopened\else
5133 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
5134 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
5137 \iflinks
5138 {\atdummies
5139 \edef\temp{%
5140 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
5141 \temp
5146 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
5147 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
5148 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
5149 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
5150 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
5151 % `1', and two named `2'.
5152 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
5156 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
5157 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
5158 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
5160 \def\activecatcodes{%
5161 \catcode`\"=\active
5162 \catcode`\$=\active
5163 \catcode`\<=\active
5164 \catcode`\>=\active
5165 \catcode`\\=\active
5166 \catcode`\^=\active
5167 \catcode`\_=\active
5168 \catcode`\|=\active
5169 \catcode`\~=\active
5173 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
5174 \def\readtocfile{%
5175 \setupdatafile
5176 \activecatcodes
5177 \input \tocreadfilename
5180 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
5181 \newcount\savepageno
5182 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
5184 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
5186 \def\startcontents#1{%
5187 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
5188 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
5189 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
5190 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
5191 \contentsalignmacro
5192 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
5194 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
5195 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
5196 \def\thischapter{}%
5197 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
5199 \savepageno = \pageno
5200 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
5201 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
5202 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
5204 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
5205 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
5208 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
5209 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
5211 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
5213 % Normal (long) toc.
5215 \def\contents{%
5216 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
5217 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5218 \ifeof 1 \else
5219 \readtocfile
5221 \vfill \eject
5222 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5223 \ifeof 1 \else
5224 \pdfmakeoutlines
5226 \closein 1
5227 \endgroup
5228 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
5229 \global\pageno = \savepageno
5232 % And just the chapters.
5233 \def\summarycontents{%
5234 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
5236 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
5237 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
5238 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
5239 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
5240 \secfonts
5241 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
5242 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
5244 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
5245 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
5246 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
5247 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
5248 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
5249 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5250 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5251 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5252 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5253 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5254 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5255 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5256 \ifeof 1 \else
5257 \readtocfile
5259 \closein 1
5260 \vfill \eject
5261 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5262 \endgroup
5263 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
5264 \global\pageno = \savepageno
5266 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
5268 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
5269 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
5271 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
5272 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
5273 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
5274 % But use \hss just in case.
5275 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
5276 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
5278 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
5279 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
5280 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
5281 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
5282 % there are before deciding ...
5283 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
5286 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
5287 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
5288 % The last argument is the page number.
5289 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
5291 % Chapters, in the main contents.
5292 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5294 % Chapters, in the short toc.
5295 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
5296 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
5297 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
5300 % Appendices, in the main contents.
5301 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
5303 \def\appendixbox#1{%
5304 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
5305 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
5306 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
5308 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5310 % Unnumbered chapters.
5311 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
5312 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
5314 % Sections.
5315 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5316 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
5317 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
5319 % Subsections.
5320 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5321 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
5322 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5324 % And subsubsections.
5325 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5326 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
5327 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5329 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
5330 % Same as \defaultparindent.
5331 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
5333 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
5334 % page number.
5336 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
5337 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
5338 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
5339 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
5340 \begingroup
5341 \chapentryfonts
5342 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5343 \endgroup
5344 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
5347 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5348 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
5349 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5350 \endgroup}
5352 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5353 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
5354 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5355 \endgroup}
5357 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5358 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
5359 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5360 \endgroup}
5362 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
5363 \let\tocentry = \entry
5365 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
5366 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
5368 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5369 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5371 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
5372 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
5373 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5374 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5377 \message{environments,}
5378 % @foo ... @end foo.
5380 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
5382 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
5383 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
5385 \def\point{$\star$}
5386 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
5387 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
5388 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
5389 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
5391 % The @error{} command.
5392 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
5394 \newbox\errorbox
5396 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
5397 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
5398 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
5399 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
5401 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
5402 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
5403 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
5404 \vbox{%
5405 \hrule height\dimen2
5406 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
5407 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
5408 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
5409 \hrule height\dimen2}
5410 \hfil}
5412 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
5414 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
5415 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
5416 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
5418 \envdef\tex{%
5419 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
5420 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
5421 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
5422 \catcode `\%=14
5423 \catcode `\+=\other
5424 \catcode `\"=\other
5425 \catcode `\|=\other
5426 \catcode `\<=\other
5427 \catcode `\>=\other
5428 \escapechar=`\\
5430 \let\b=\ptexb
5431 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
5432 \let\c=\ptexc
5433 \let\,=\ptexcomma
5434 \let\.=\ptexdot
5435 \let\dots=\ptexdots
5436 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
5437 \let\!=\ptexexclam
5438 \let\i=\ptexi
5439 \let\indent=\ptexindent
5440 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
5441 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
5442 \let\+=\tabalign
5443 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
5444 \let\/=\ptexslash
5445 \let\*=\ptexstar
5446 \let\t=\ptext
5447 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
5449 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
5450 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
5451 \def\@{@}%
5453 % There is no need to define \Etex.
5455 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
5456 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
5457 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
5459 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
5460 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
5462 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
5463 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
5464 % have any width.
5465 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
5467 % This space is always present above and below environments.
5468 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
5470 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
5471 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
5472 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
5473 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
5475 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
5476 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
5477 % \sectionheading, q.v.
5478 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
5479 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
5480 \endgraf
5481 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
5482 \removelastskip
5483 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
5484 % or better ...
5485 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
5486 \vskip\envskipamount
5491 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
5493 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
5494 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
5495 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
5497 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
5498 % environment contents.
5499 \font\circle=lcircle10
5500 \newdimen\circthick
5501 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
5502 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
5503 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
5505 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
5506 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
5507 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
5508 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
5509 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5510 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
5511 \hskip\rskip}}
5512 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5513 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
5514 \hskip\rskip}}
5516 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
5518 \envdef\cartouche{%
5519 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
5520 \startsavinginserts
5521 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
5522 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
5523 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
5524 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
5525 \cartouter=\hsize
5526 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
5527 % side, and for 6pt waste from
5528 % each corner char, and rule thickness
5529 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
5530 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
5531 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5532 \vbox\bgroup
5533 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
5534 \carttop
5535 \hbox\bgroup
5536 \hskip\lskip
5537 \vrule\kern3pt
5538 \vbox\bgroup
5539 \kern3pt
5540 \hsize=\cartinner
5541 \baselineskip=\normbskip
5542 \lineskip=\normlskip
5543 \parskip=\normpskip
5544 \vskip -\parskip
5545 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
5547 \def\Ecartouche{%
5548 \ifhmode\par\fi
5549 \kern3pt
5550 \egroup
5551 \kern3pt\vrule
5552 \hskip\rskip
5553 \egroup
5554 \cartbot
5555 \egroup
5556 \checkinserts
5560 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
5561 % inside a group.
5562 \def\nonfillstart{%
5563 \aboveenvbreak
5564 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
5565 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
5566 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
5567 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
5568 \parskip = 0pt
5569 \parindent = 0pt
5570 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
5571 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5572 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
5573 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
5574 \else
5575 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
5577 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
5580 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
5581 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
5582 % This affects the following displayed environments:
5583 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
5585 \def\smallword{small}
5586 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
5587 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
5588 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
5589 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
5590 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
5591 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
5592 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
5593 % to change the fonts afterward.
5594 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5595 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5598 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
5599 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
5600 \else
5601 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5602 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5606 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
5607 % Let's do it by one command:
5608 \def\makedispenv #1#2{
5609 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
5610 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
5611 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5612 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5615 % Define two synonyms:
5616 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
5617 \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
5618 \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
5621 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
5623 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
5624 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
5626 \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
5627 \nonfillstart
5628 \tt\quoteexpand
5629 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
5630 \gobble % eat return
5632 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
5634 \makedispenv {display}{%
5635 \nonfillstart
5636 \gobble
5639 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
5641 \makedispenv{format}{%
5642 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5643 \nonfillstart
5644 \gobble
5647 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
5648 \envdef\flushleft{%
5649 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5650 \nonfillstart
5651 \gobble
5653 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
5655 % @flushright.
5657 \envdef\flushright{%
5658 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5659 \nonfillstart
5660 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
5661 \gobble
5663 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
5666 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
5667 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
5668 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
5669 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
5671 \envdef\quotation{%
5672 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
5673 \parindent=0pt
5675 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
5676 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5677 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
5678 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
5679 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
5680 \else
5681 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
5683 \parsearg\quotationlabel
5686 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
5687 % doing normal filling.
5689 \def\Equotation{%
5690 \par
5691 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
5692 % indent a bit.
5693 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
5695 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
5698 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
5699 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
5700 \def\temp{#1}%
5701 \ifx\temp\empty \else
5702 {\bf #1: }%
5707 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
5708 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
5709 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
5710 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
5712 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
5714 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
5715 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
5716 % verbatim line.
5717 \def\dospecials{%
5718 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
5719 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
5720 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
5723 % [Knuth] p. 380
5724 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
5725 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
5727 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
5728 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
5729 \begingroup
5730 \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
5731 \endgroup
5733 % Setup for the @verb command.
5735 % Eight spaces for a tab
5736 \begingroup
5737 \catcode`\^^I=\active
5738 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
5739 \endgroup
5741 \def\setupverb{%
5742 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
5743 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
5744 \catcode`\`=\active
5745 \tabeightspaces
5746 % Respect line breaks,
5747 % print special symbols as themselves, and
5748 % make each space count
5749 % must do in this order:
5750 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
5753 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
5755 % Real tab expansion
5756 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
5758 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
5760 % Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
5761 % quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
5762 % from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
5763 % the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
5764 % evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
5765 % regular 0x27.
5767 \def\codequoteright{%
5768 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
5769 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
5771 \else \char'15 \fi
5772 \else \char'15 \fi
5775 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
5776 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
5777 % the code environments to do likewise.
5779 \def\codequoteleft{%
5780 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
5781 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
5783 \else \char'22 \fi
5784 \else \char'22 \fi
5787 \begingroup
5788 \catcode`\^^I=\active
5789 \gdef\tabexpand{%
5790 \catcode`\^^I=\active
5791 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
5792 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
5793 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
5794 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
5795 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
5796 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
5799 \catcode`\'=\active
5800 \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=\active \def'{\codequoteright}}%
5802 \catcode`\`=\active
5803 \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=\active \def`{\codequoteleft}}%
5805 \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
5806 \endgroup
5808 % start the verbatim environment.
5809 \def\setupverbatim{%
5810 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5811 \nonfillstart
5812 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
5814 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
5815 \catcode`\`=\active
5816 \tabexpand
5817 \quoteexpand
5818 % Respect line breaks,
5819 % print special symbols as themselves, and
5820 % make each space count
5821 % must do in this order:
5822 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
5823 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
5826 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
5827 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
5828 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
5830 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
5832 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
5833 \begingroup
5834 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
5835 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
5836 \endgroup
5838 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
5841 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
5842 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
5844 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
5846 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
5847 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
5848 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
5850 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
5852 \begingroup
5853 \catcode`\ =\active
5854 \obeylines %
5855 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
5856 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
5857 % line in the output.
5858 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
5859 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
5860 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
5861 \endgroup
5863 \envdef\verbatim{%
5864 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
5866 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
5869 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
5871 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
5873 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
5875 \makevalueexpandable
5876 \setupverbatim
5877 \input #1
5878 \afterenvbreak
5882 % @copying ... @end copying.
5883 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
5885 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
5886 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
5887 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
5888 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
5889 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
5890 % possible is very desirable.
5892 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
5893 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
5895 \def\insertcopying{%
5896 \begingroup
5897 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
5898 \scanexp\copyingtext
5899 \endgroup
5903 \message{defuns,}
5904 % @defun etc.
5906 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
5907 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
5908 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
5909 \newcount\defunpenalty
5911 % Start the processing of @deffn:
5912 \def\startdefun{%
5913 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
5914 \medbreak
5915 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
5916 % following @def command, see below.
5917 \else
5918 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
5919 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
5920 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
5921 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
5922 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
5923 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
5924 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
5926 % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
5927 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
5928 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
5929 % @def command.
5930 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
5932 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
5933 % But do insert the glue.
5934 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
5937 \parindent=0in
5938 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
5939 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
5942 \def\dodefunx#1{%
5943 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
5944 \checkenv#1%
5946 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
5947 % It's not a great place, though.
5948 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
5950 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
5951 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
5953 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
5955 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
5957 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
5958 \begingroup
5959 % call \deffnheader:
5960 #1#2 \endheader
5961 % common ending:
5962 \interlinepenalty = 10000
5963 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
5964 \endgraf
5965 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
5966 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
5967 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
5968 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
5969 \checkparencounts
5970 \endgroup
5973 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
5975 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
5976 % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
5978 \def\makedefun#1{%
5979 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
5980 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
5981 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
5982 \temp
5985 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
5987 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
5988 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
5990 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
5991 \envdef#1{%
5992 \startdefun
5993 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
5995 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
5996 \def#3%
5999 %%% Untyped functions:
6001 % @deffn category name args
6002 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
6004 % @deffn category class name args
6005 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6007 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6008 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6010 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6012 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6013 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6014 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6015 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6018 %%% Typed functions:
6020 % @deftypefn category type name args
6021 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6023 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6024 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6026 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6027 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6029 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
6031 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6032 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6033 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6036 %%% Typed variables:
6038 % @deftypevr category type var args
6039 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
6041 % @deftypecv category class type var args
6042 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
6044 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
6045 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6047 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
6049 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6050 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6051 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6054 %%% Untyped variables:
6056 % @defvr category var args
6057 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
6059 % @defcv category class var args
6060 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
6062 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
6063 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
6065 %%% Type:
6066 % @deftp category name args
6067 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
6068 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
6069 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
6072 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
6073 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6074 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
6075 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
6076 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6077 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6078 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
6079 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6080 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
6081 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
6082 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6083 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6085 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
6086 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
6087 % #2 is the return type, if any.
6088 % #3 is the function name.
6090 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
6092 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
6093 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
6094 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
6096 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
6097 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
6098 % just below it.
6099 \def\temp{#1}%
6100 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
6102 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
6103 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
6104 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
6105 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
6106 % The continuations:
6107 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
6108 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
6109 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
6111 % Put the type name to the right margin.
6112 \noindent
6113 \hbox to 0pt{%
6114 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
6115 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
6116 \kern\leftskip
6117 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
6120 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
6121 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
6122 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6124 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
6125 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
6126 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
6127 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
6128 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
6129 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
6130 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
6131 % one has made identifiers using them :).
6132 \df \tt
6133 \def\temp{#2}% return value type
6134 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
6135 #3% output function name
6137 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
6139 \boldbrax
6140 % arguments will be output next, if any.
6143 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
6144 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
6145 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
6146 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
6148 \def\defunargs#1{%
6149 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
6150 % tt for the names.
6151 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
6153 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
6154 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
6155 \let\var=\ttslanted
6157 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
6160 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
6162 \def\activeparens{%
6163 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
6164 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
6165 \catcode`\&=\active
6168 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
6169 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
6171 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
6172 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
6173 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
6175 \activeparens
6176 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
6177 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
6178 \global\let& = \&
6180 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
6181 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
6184 \newcount\parencount
6186 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
6187 \newif\ifampseen
6188 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
6190 \def\parenfont{%
6191 \ifampseen
6192 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
6193 % otherwise use the default font.
6194 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
6195 \else
6196 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
6197 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
6201 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
6202 \ifampseen
6203 \ifnum\parencount=1
6208 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
6210 \def\opnr{%
6211 \global\advance\parencount by 1
6212 {\parenfont(}%
6213 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
6215 \def\clnr{%
6216 {\parenfont)}%
6217 \infirstlevel \sl
6218 \global\advance\parencount by -1
6221 \newcount\brackcount
6222 \def\lbrb{%
6223 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
6224 {\bf[}%
6226 \def\rbrb{%
6227 {\bf]}%
6228 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
6231 \def\checkparencounts{%
6232 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
6233 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
6235 \def\badparencount{%
6236 \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}%
6237 \global\parencount=0
6239 \def\badbrackcount{%
6240 \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}%
6241 \global\brackcount=0
6245 \message{macros,}
6246 % @macro.
6248 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
6249 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
6250 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
6251 \newwrite\macscribble
6252 \def\scantokens#1{%
6253 \toks0={#1}%
6254 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
6255 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
6256 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
6257 \input \jobname.tmp
6261 \def\scanmacro#1{%
6262 \begingroup
6263 \newlinechar`\^^M
6264 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
6265 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
6266 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
6267 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
6268 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
6269 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
6270 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
6271 % ... and \example
6272 \spaceisspace
6274 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
6275 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
6276 % --kasal, 29nov03
6277 \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
6278 \endgroup
6281 \def\scanexp#1{%
6282 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
6283 \temp
6286 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
6287 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
6288 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
6290 % List of all defined macros in the form
6291 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
6292 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
6293 % if there is a need.
6294 \def\macrolist{}
6296 % Add the macro to \macrolist
6297 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
6298 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
6299 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
6300 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
6303 % Utility routines.
6304 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
6305 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
6306 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
6308 \def\cslet#1#2{%
6309 \expandafter\let
6310 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
6311 \csname#2\endcsname
6314 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
6315 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
6316 {\catcode`\@=11
6317 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
6318 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
6319 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
6320 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
6321 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
6324 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
6325 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
6326 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
6327 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
6328 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
6331 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
6332 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
6333 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
6335 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
6336 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
6337 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
6339 \def\scanctxt{%
6340 \catcode`\"=\other
6341 \catcode`\+=\other
6342 \catcode`\<=\other
6343 \catcode`\>=\other
6344 \catcode`\@=\other
6345 \catcode`\^=\other
6346 \catcode`\_=\other
6347 \catcode`\|=\other
6348 \catcode`\~=\other
6351 \def\scanargctxt{%
6352 \scanctxt
6353 \catcode`\\=\other
6354 \catcode`\^^M=\other
6357 \def\macrobodyctxt{%
6358 \scanctxt
6359 \catcode`\{=\other
6360 \catcode`\}=\other
6361 \catcode`\^^M=\other
6362 \usembodybackslash
6365 \def\macroargctxt{%
6366 \scanctxt
6367 \catcode`\\=\other
6370 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
6371 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
6372 % where N is the macro parameter number.
6373 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
6374 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
6376 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
6377 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
6378 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
6380 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
6382 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
6383 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
6385 \def\macroxxx#1{%
6386 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
6387 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
6388 \paramno=0%
6389 \else
6390 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
6392 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
6393 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
6394 \else
6395 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
6396 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
6397 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
6398 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
6399 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
6401 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
6402 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
6403 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
6404 \fi}
6406 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
6407 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
6408 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
6409 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
6410 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
6411 \begingroup
6412 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
6413 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
6414 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
6415 \endgroup
6416 \else
6417 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
6421 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
6422 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
6424 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
6425 \ifx #1\relax
6426 % remove this
6427 \else
6428 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
6432 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
6433 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
6434 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
6435 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
6436 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
6437 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
6438 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
6440 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
6441 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
6442 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
6443 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
6445 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
6446 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
6447 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
6448 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
6450 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
6451 % the macro is used.
6453 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
6454 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
6455 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
6456 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
6457 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
6458 \advance\paramno by 1%
6459 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
6460 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
6461 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
6462 \fi\next}
6464 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
6465 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
6467 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
6468 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6469 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
6470 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6472 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
6473 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
6474 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
6475 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
6476 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
6477 \def\defmacro{%
6478 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
6479 \ifrecursive
6480 \ifcase\paramno
6482 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6483 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6484 \or % 1
6485 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6486 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6487 \noexpand\braceorline
6488 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
6489 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
6490 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6491 \else % many
6492 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6493 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6494 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
6495 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
6496 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
6497 \expandafter\expandafter
6498 \expandafter\xdef
6499 \expandafter\expandafter
6500 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
6501 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6503 \else
6504 \ifcase\paramno
6506 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6507 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6508 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6509 \or % 1
6510 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6511 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6512 \noexpand\braceorline
6513 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
6514 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
6515 \egroup
6516 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6517 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6518 \else % many
6519 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6520 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6521 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
6522 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
6523 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
6524 \expandafter\expandafter
6525 \expandafter\xdef
6526 \expandafter\expandafter
6527 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
6528 \paramlist{%
6529 \egroup
6530 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6531 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6533 \fi}
6535 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
6537 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
6538 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
6539 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
6540 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
6541 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
6542 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
6543 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
6544 \expandafter\parsearg
6545 \fi \macnamexxx}
6548 % @alias.
6549 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
6550 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
6551 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
6552 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
6553 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
6555 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
6556 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
6557 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
6559 \next
6563 \message{cross references,}
6565 \newwrite\auxfile
6566 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
6567 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
6569 % @inforef is relatively simple.
6570 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
6571 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
6572 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
6574 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
6575 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
6576 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
6577 % @node foo , bar , ...
6578 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
6580 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
6582 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
6583 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
6584 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
6585 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
6587 \let\nwnode=\node
6588 \let\lastnode=\empty
6590 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
6591 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
6593 \def\donoderef#1{%
6594 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
6595 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
6596 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
6600 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
6602 \newcount\savesfregister
6604 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
6605 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
6606 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
6608 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
6609 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
6610 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection,
6611 % or the anchor name.
6612 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
6613 % empty for anchors.
6614 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
6616 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
6617 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
6618 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
6620 \def\setref#1#2{%
6621 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
6622 \iflinks
6624 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
6625 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
6626 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
6627 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
6629 \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}%
6630 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
6631 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
6632 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
6637 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
6638 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
6639 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
6640 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
6642 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6643 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6644 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6645 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
6646 \unsepspaces
6647 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
6648 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
6649 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
6650 \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
6651 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
6652 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
6653 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
6654 % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
6655 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6656 \else
6657 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
6658 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
6659 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6660 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
6661 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6662 \else
6663 \ifhavexrefs
6664 % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
6665 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
6666 \else
6667 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
6668 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6669 \fi%
6674 % Make link in pdf output.
6675 \ifpdf
6676 \leavevmode
6677 \getfilename{#4}%
6678 {\indexnofonts
6679 \turnoffactive
6680 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
6681 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
6682 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
6684 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
6685 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
6686 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
6687 \else
6688 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
6689 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
6692 \linkcolor
6695 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
6696 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
6697 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
6699 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
6700 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
6701 \indexnofonts
6702 \turnoffactive
6703 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
6704 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
6706 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
6707 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
6708 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
6709 \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
6710 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
6711 \else
6712 \printedrefname
6715 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
6716 % "in MANUALNAME".
6717 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6718 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6720 \else
6721 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
6723 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
6724 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
6725 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
6726 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
6727 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
6728 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
6729 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6730 \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6731 \else
6732 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
6733 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
6734 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
6735 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
6736 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
6737 {\turnoffactive
6738 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
6739 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
6740 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
6741 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
6743 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
6744 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
6746 % But we always want a comma and a space:
6747 ,\space
6749 % output the `page 3'.
6750 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
6753 \endlink
6754 \endgroup}
6756 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
6757 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
6758 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
6759 % one that Bob is working on :).
6761 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
6763 % Things referred to by \setref.
6765 \def\Ynothing{}
6766 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
6767 \def\Ynumbered{%
6768 \ifnum\secno=0
6769 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
6770 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
6771 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
6772 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
6773 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
6774 \else
6775 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
6776 \fi\fi\fi
6778 \def\Yappendix{%
6779 \ifnum\secno=0
6780 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
6781 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
6782 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
6783 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
6784 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
6785 \else
6786 \putwordSection@tie
6787 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
6788 \fi\fi\fi
6791 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
6792 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
6794 \def\refx#1#2{%
6796 \indexnofonts
6797 \otherbackslash
6798 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
6799 \csname XR#1\endcsname
6801 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
6802 % If not defined, say something at least.
6803 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
6804 \iflinks
6805 \ifhavexrefs
6806 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
6807 \else
6808 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
6809 \global\warnedxrefstrue
6810 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
6814 \else
6815 % It's defined, so just use it.
6816 \thisrefX
6818 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
6821 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
6822 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
6823 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
6825 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
6826 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
6827 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
6828 % mess up the control sequence name.
6829 \indexnofonts
6830 \turnoffactive
6831 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
6834 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
6836 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
6837 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
6838 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
6839 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
6840 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
6842 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
6843 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
6844 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
6845 \else
6846 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
6847 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
6850 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
6851 % for later use in \listoffloats.
6852 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
6853 {\safexrefname}}%
6857 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
6859 \def\tryauxfile{%
6860 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
6861 \ifeof 1 \else
6862 \readdatafile{aux}%
6863 \global\havexrefstrue
6865 \closein 1
6868 \def\setupdatafile{%
6869 \catcode`\^^@=\other
6870 \catcode`\^^A=\other
6871 \catcode`\^^B=\other
6872 \catcode`\^^C=\other
6873 \catcode`\^^D=\other
6874 \catcode`\^^E=\other
6875 \catcode`\^^F=\other
6876 \catcode`\^^G=\other
6877 \catcode`\^^H=\other
6878 \catcode`\^^K=\other
6879 \catcode`\^^L=\other
6880 \catcode`\^^N=\other
6881 \catcode`\^^P=\other
6882 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
6883 \catcode`\^^R=\other
6884 \catcode`\^^S=\other
6885 \catcode`\^^T=\other
6886 \catcode`\^^U=\other
6887 \catcode`\^^V=\other
6888 \catcode`\^^W=\other
6889 \catcode`\^^X=\other
6890 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
6891 \catcode`\^^[=\other
6892 \catcode`\^^\=\other
6893 \catcode`\^^]=\other
6894 \catcode`\^^^=\other
6895 \catcode`\^^_=\other
6896 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
6897 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
6898 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
6899 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
6900 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
6901 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
6902 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
6903 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
6905 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
6906 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
6907 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
6909 \catcode`\^=\other
6911 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
6912 \catcode`\~=\other
6913 \catcode`\[=\other
6914 \catcode`\]=\other
6915 \catcode`\"=\other
6916 \catcode`\_=\other
6917 \catcode`\|=\other
6918 \catcode`\<=\other
6919 \catcode`\>=\other
6920 \catcode`\$=\other
6921 \catcode`\#=\other
6922 \catcode`\&=\other
6923 \catcode`\%=\other
6924 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
6926 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
6927 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
6928 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
6929 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
6930 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
6931 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
6932 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
6933 \catcode`\\=\other
6935 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
6937 \count1=128
6938 \def\loop{%
6939 \catcode\count1=\other
6940 \advance\count1 by 1
6941 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
6945 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
6946 \catcode`\{=1
6947 \catcode`\}=2
6948 \catcode`\@=0
6951 \def\readdatafile#1{%
6952 \begingroup
6953 \setupdatafile
6954 \input\jobname.#1
6955 \endgroup}
6958 \message{insertions,}
6959 % including footnotes.
6961 \newcount \footnoteno
6963 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
6964 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
6965 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
6966 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
6967 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
6968 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
6970 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
6971 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
6973 {\catcode `\@=11
6975 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
6976 \gdef\footnote{%
6977 \let\indent=\ptexindent
6978 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
6979 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
6980 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
6982 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
6983 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
6984 \let\@sf\empty
6985 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
6987 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
6988 \unskip
6989 \thisfootno\@sf
6990 \dofootnote
6993 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
6994 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
6996 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
6997 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
6998 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
7000 \gdef\dofootnote{%
7001 \insert\footins\bgroup
7002 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
7003 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
7004 % So reset some parameters.
7005 \hsize=\pagewidth
7006 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
7007 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
7008 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
7009 \floatingpenalty\@MM
7010 \leftskip\z@skip
7011 \rightskip\z@skip
7012 \spaceskip\z@skip
7013 \xspaceskip\z@skip
7014 \parindent\defaultparindent
7016 \smallfonts \rm
7018 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
7019 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
7020 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
7021 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
7022 \let\noindent = \relax
7024 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
7025 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
7026 \everypar = {\hang}%
7027 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
7029 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
7030 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
7031 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
7032 \footstrut
7033 \futurelet\next\fo@t
7035 }%end \catcode `\@=11
7037 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
7038 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
7039 % would be lost.
7040 % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
7041 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
7042 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
7044 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
7045 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
7046 % out prematurely.
7048 \def\startsavinginserts{%
7049 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
7050 \let\insert\saveinsert
7051 \else
7052 \let\checkinserts\relax
7056 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
7057 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
7059 \def\saveinsert#1{%
7060 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
7061 \afterassignment\next
7062 % swallow the left brace
7063 \let\temp =
7065 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
7066 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
7068 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
7070 \def\placesaveins#1{%
7071 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
7072 {\box#1}%
7075 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
7077 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
7078 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
7081 % initialization:
7082 \def\newsaveins #1{%
7083 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
7084 \next
7086 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
7087 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
7088 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
7089 \checksaveins #1}%
7092 % initialize:
7093 \let\checkinserts\empty
7094 \newsaveins\footins
7095 \newsaveins\margin
7098 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
7099 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
7101 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
7102 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
7103 % undone and the next image would fail.
7104 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
7105 \ifeof 1 \else
7106 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
7107 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
7108 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
7109 \input epsf.tex
7111 \closein 1
7113 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
7114 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
7115 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
7116 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
7117 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
7119 \def\image#1{%
7120 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
7121 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
7122 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
7123 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
7124 \global\warnednoepsftrue
7126 \else
7127 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
7131 % Arguments to @image:
7132 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
7133 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
7134 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
7135 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
7136 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
7137 \newif\ifimagevmode
7138 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
7139 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
7140 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
7141 % If the image is by itself, center it.
7142 \ifvmode
7143 \imagevmodetrue
7144 \nobreak\bigskip
7145 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
7146 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
7147 % above and below.
7148 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
7149 \nobreak
7150 \line\bgroup
7153 % Output the image.
7154 \ifpdf
7155 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
7156 \else
7157 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
7158 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
7159 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
7160 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
7163 \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
7164 \endgroup}
7167 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
7168 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
7169 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
7171 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
7173 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
7174 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
7176 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
7177 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
7178 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
7180 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
7181 % be referable.
7183 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
7184 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
7186 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
7187 % chapter-level command.
7188 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
7190 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
7191 \let\thiscaption=\empty
7192 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
7194 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
7196 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
7197 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
7199 \startsavinginserts
7201 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
7202 \par
7204 \vtop\bgroup
7205 \def\floattype{#1}%
7206 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
7207 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
7209 \ifx\floattype\empty
7210 \let\safefloattype=\empty
7211 \else
7213 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7214 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7215 \indexnofonts
7216 \turnoffactive
7217 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7221 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
7222 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7223 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
7224 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
7226 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
7227 \global\advance\floatno by 1
7230 % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the
7231 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
7232 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
7233 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
7234 % lists of floats.
7236 \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
7237 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
7241 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
7242 \vskip\parskip
7244 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
7245 \restorefirstparagraphindent
7248 % we have these possibilities:
7249 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
7250 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
7251 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
7252 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
7253 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
7254 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
7255 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
7256 % @float & no caption:
7258 \def\Efloat{%
7259 \let\floatident = \empty
7261 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
7262 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
7264 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
7265 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7266 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
7267 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
7269 % the number.
7270 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7273 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
7274 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
7275 \let\captionline = \floatident
7277 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
7278 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
7279 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
7282 % caption text.
7283 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
7286 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
7287 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
7288 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
7289 \vskip.5\parskip
7290 \captionline
7292 % Space below caption.
7293 \vskip\parskip
7296 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
7297 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
7298 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7299 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
7300 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
7301 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
7303 \atdummies
7305 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
7306 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
7307 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
7308 \scanexp{%
7309 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
7310 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
7311 \thiscaption
7312 \else
7313 \thisshortcaption
7317 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
7318 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
7321 \egroup % end of \vtop
7323 % place the captured inserts
7325 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
7326 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
7327 % float. --kasal, 26may04
7329 \checkinserts
7332 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
7334 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
7335 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
7338 % @caption, @shortcaption
7340 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
7341 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
7342 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
7343 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
7345 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
7346 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
7347 \def\getfloatno#1{%
7348 \ifx#1\relax
7349 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
7350 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
7352 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
7353 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
7354 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
7356 \let\floatno#1%
7359 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
7360 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
7361 % first read the @float command.
7363 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7365 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
7366 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
7367 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
7369 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
7370 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
7371 % \thissection value which we \setref above.
7373 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
7375 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
7376 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
7378 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
7379 \def\temp{#1}%
7380 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
7381 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
7384 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
7386 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
7387 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
7389 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7390 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7391 \indexnofonts
7392 \turnoffactive
7393 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7396 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
7397 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
7398 \ifhavexrefs
7399 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
7400 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
7402 \else
7403 \begingroup
7404 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
7405 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
7406 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
7407 \endgroup
7411 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
7412 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
7413 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
7414 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
7416 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
7417 % they won't appear in the aux file).
7419 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
7420 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
7421 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
7422 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
7423 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
7424 % in pdf output.
7425 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
7427 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
7428 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
7429 \writeentry
7433 \message{localization,}
7435 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
7436 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
7437 % properly. Single argument is the language (de) or locale (de_DE)
7438 % abbreviation. It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file.
7441 \catcode`\_ = \active
7442 \globaldefs=1
7443 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
7444 \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
7445 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
7446 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
7447 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
7448 \ifeof 1
7449 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
7450 \else
7451 \input txi-#1.tex
7453 \closein 1
7454 \endgroup
7455 \endgroup}
7458 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
7459 % try txi-de.tex.
7461 \def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
7462 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
7463 \ifeof 1
7464 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
7465 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
7466 \else
7467 \input txi-#1.tex
7469 \closein 1
7472 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
7473 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
7474 should work if nowhere else does.}
7476 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
7478 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
7479 \count255=128
7480 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
7481 \global\catcode\count255=#1
7482 \advance\count255 by 1
7483 \repeat
7486 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
7487 % according to the specified encoding.
7489 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
7490 % Encoding being declared for the document.
7491 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
7493 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
7494 % to compare them with \ifx.
7495 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
7496 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
7497 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
7498 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
7499 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
7501 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
7502 \asciichardefs
7504 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
7505 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7506 \lattwochardefs
7508 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
7509 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7510 \latonechardefs
7512 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
7513 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7514 \latninechardefs
7516 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
7517 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7518 \utfeightchardefs
7520 \else
7521 \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
7523 \fi % utfeight
7524 \fi % latnine
7525 \fi % latone
7526 \fi % lattwo
7527 \fi % ascii
7530 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
7531 % the default font encoding (OT1).
7533 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
7535 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
7536 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
7538 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
7539 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
7540 % macros containing the character definitions.
7541 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7543 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
7544 \def\latonechardefs{%
7545 \gdef^^a0{~}
7546 \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
7547 \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
7548 \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
7549 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
7550 \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
7551 \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
7552 \gdef^^a7{\S}
7553 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
7554 \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
7555 \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
7556 \gdef^^ab{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
7557 \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
7558 \gdef^^ad{\-}
7559 \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
7560 \gdef^^af{\={}}
7562 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
7563 \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
7564 \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
7565 \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
7566 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
7567 \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
7568 \gdef^^b6{\P}
7570 \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
7571 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
7572 \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
7573 \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
7575 \gdef^^bb{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
7576 \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
7577 \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
7578 \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
7579 \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
7581 \gdef^^c0{\`A}
7582 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
7583 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
7584 \gdef^^c3{\~A}
7585 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
7586 \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
7587 \gdef^^c6{\AE}
7588 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
7589 \gdef^^c8{\`E}
7590 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
7591 \gdef^^ca{\^E}
7592 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
7593 \gdef^^cc{\`I}
7594 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
7595 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
7596 \gdef^^cf{\"I}
7598 \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH}}
7599 \gdef^^d1{\~N}
7600 \gdef^^d2{\`O}
7601 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
7602 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
7603 \gdef^^d5{\~O}
7604 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
7605 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
7606 \gdef^^d8{\O}
7607 \gdef^^d9{\`U}
7608 \gdef^^da{\'U}
7609 \gdef^^db{\^U}
7610 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
7611 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
7612 \gdef^^de{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN}}
7613 \gdef^^df{\ss}
7615 \gdef^^e0{\`a}
7616 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
7617 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
7618 \gdef^^e3{\~a}
7619 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
7620 \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
7621 \gdef^^e6{\ae}
7622 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
7623 \gdef^^e8{\`e}
7624 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
7625 \gdef^^ea{\^e}
7626 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
7627 \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
7628 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
7629 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
7630 \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
7632 \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH}}
7633 \gdef^^f1{\~n}
7634 \gdef^^f2{\`o}
7635 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
7636 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
7637 \gdef^^f5{\~o}
7638 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
7639 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
7640 \gdef^^f8{\o}
7641 \gdef^^f9{\`u}
7642 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
7643 \gdef^^fb{\^u}
7644 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
7645 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
7646 \gdef^^fe{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN}}
7647 \gdef^^ff{\"y}
7650 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
7651 \def\latninechardefs{%
7652 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
7653 \latonechardefs
7655 \gdef^^a4{\euro}
7656 \gdef^^a6{\v S}
7657 \gdef^^a8{\v s}
7658 \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
7659 \gdef^^b8{\v z}
7660 \gdef^^bc{\OE}
7661 \gdef^^bd{\oe}
7662 \gdef^^be{\"Y}
7665 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
7666 \def\lattwochardefs{%
7667 \gdef^^a0{~}
7668 \gdef^^a1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
7669 \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
7670 \gdef^^a3{\L}
7671 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
7672 \gdef^^a5{\v L}
7673 \gdef^^a6{\'S}
7674 \gdef^^a7{\S}
7675 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
7676 \gdef^^a9{\v S}
7677 \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
7678 \gdef^^ab{\v T}
7679 \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
7680 \gdef^^ad{\-}
7681 \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
7682 \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
7684 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
7685 \gdef^^b1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
7686 \gdef^^b2{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK}}
7687 \gdef^^b3{\l}
7688 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
7689 \gdef^^b5{\v l}
7690 \gdef^^b6{\'s}
7691 \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
7692 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
7693 \gdef^^b9{\v s}
7694 \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
7695 \gdef^^bb{\v t}
7696 \gdef^^bc{\'z}
7697 \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
7698 \gdef^^be{\v z}
7699 \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
7701 \gdef^^c0{\'R}
7702 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
7703 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
7704 \gdef^^c3{\u A}
7705 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
7706 \gdef^^c5{\'L}
7707 \gdef^^c6{\'C}
7708 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
7709 \gdef^^c8{\v C}
7710 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
7711 \gdef^^ca{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
7712 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
7713 \gdef^^cc{\v E}
7714 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
7715 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
7716 \gdef^^cf{\v D}
7718 \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
7719 \gdef^^d1{\'N}
7720 \gdef^^d2{\v N}
7721 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
7722 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
7723 \gdef^^d5{\H O}
7724 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
7725 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
7726 \gdef^^d8{\v R}
7727 \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
7728 \gdef^^da{\'U}
7729 \gdef^^db{\H U}
7730 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
7731 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
7732 \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
7733 \gdef^^df{\ss}
7735 \gdef^^e0{\'r}
7736 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
7737 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
7738 \gdef^^e3{\u a}
7739 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
7740 \gdef^^e5{\'l}
7741 \gdef^^e6{\'c}
7742 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
7743 \gdef^^e8{\v c}
7744 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
7745 \gdef^^ea{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
7746 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
7747 \gdef^^ec{\v e}
7748 \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
7749 \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
7750 \gdef^^ef{\v d}
7752 \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
7753 \gdef^^f1{\'n}
7754 \gdef^^f2{\v n}
7755 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
7756 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
7757 \gdef^^f5{\H o}
7758 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
7759 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
7760 \gdef^^f8{\v r}
7761 \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
7762 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
7763 \gdef^^fb{\H u}
7764 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
7765 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
7766 \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
7767 \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
7770 % UTF-8 character definitions.
7772 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
7773 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
7774 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
7776 \newcount\countUTFx
7777 \newcount\countUTFy
7778 \newcount\countUTFz
7780 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
7781 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
7783 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
7784 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
7786 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
7787 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
7789 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
7790 \ifx #1\relax
7791 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
7792 \else
7793 \expandafter #1%
7797 \begingroup
7798 \catcode`\~13
7799 \catcode`\"12
7801 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
7802 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
7803 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
7804 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
7805 \advance\countUTFx by 1
7806 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
7807 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
7808 \fi}
7810 \countUTFx = "C2
7811 \countUTFy = "E0
7812 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
7813 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
7814 \UTFviiiLoop
7816 \countUTFx = "E0
7817 \countUTFy = "F0
7818 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
7819 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
7820 \UTFviiiLoop
7822 \countUTFx = "F0
7823 \countUTFy = "F4
7824 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
7825 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
7826 \UTFviiiLoop
7827 \endgroup
7829 \begingroup
7830 \catcode`\"=12
7831 \catcode`\<=12
7832 \catcode`\.=12
7833 \catcode`\,=12
7834 \catcode`\;=12
7835 \catcode`\!=12
7836 \catcode`\~=13
7838 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
7839 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
7840 \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
7841 \begingroup
7842 \parseXMLCharref
7843 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
7844 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
7845 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
7846 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
7847 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
7848 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
7849 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
7850 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
7851 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
7852 \endgroup}
7854 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
7855 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
7856 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7857 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
7858 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
7859 \parseUTFviiiA,%
7860 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
7861 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
7862 \parseUTFviiiA;%
7863 \parseUTFviiiA,%
7864 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
7865 \else
7866 \parseUTFviiiA;%
7867 \parseUTFviiiA,%
7868 \parseUTFviiiA!%
7869 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
7870 \fi\fi\fi
7873 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
7874 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
7875 \divide\countUTFz by 64
7876 \countUTFy = \countUTFz
7877 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
7878 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
7879 \advance\countUTFx by 128
7880 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
7881 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
7883 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
7884 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
7885 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
7886 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
7887 \endgroup
7889 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
7890 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
7891 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
7892 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
7893 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
7894 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
7895 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
7896 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
7897 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
7898 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
7900 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
7901 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
7902 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
7903 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
7904 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
7906 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
7907 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
7908 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
7909 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
7910 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
7911 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
7912 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
7913 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
7914 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
7915 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
7916 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
7917 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
7918 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
7919 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
7920 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
7921 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
7923 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
7924 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
7925 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
7926 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
7927 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
7928 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
7929 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
7930 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
7931 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
7932 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
7933 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
7934 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
7935 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
7937 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
7938 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
7939 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
7940 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
7941 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
7942 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
7943 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
7944 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
7945 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
7946 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
7947 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
7948 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
7949 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
7950 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
7951 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
7952 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
7954 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
7955 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
7956 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
7957 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
7958 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
7959 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
7960 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
7961 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
7962 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
7963 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
7964 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
7965 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
7966 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
7968 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
7969 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
7970 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
7971 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
7972 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
7973 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
7974 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
7975 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
7976 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
7977 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
7978 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
7979 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
7980 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
7982 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
7983 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
7984 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
7985 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
7986 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
7987 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
7988 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
7989 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
7990 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
7991 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
7992 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
7993 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
7995 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
7996 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
7997 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
7998 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
7999 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
8000 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
8001 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
8002 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
8003 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
8004 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
8006 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
8007 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
8008 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
8009 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
8010 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
8011 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
8012 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
8013 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
8015 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
8016 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
8017 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
8018 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
8019 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
8020 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
8021 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
8022 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
8023 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
8024 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
8026 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
8027 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
8028 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
8029 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
8030 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
8031 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
8032 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
8033 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
8034 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
8035 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
8036 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
8037 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
8038 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
8039 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
8041 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
8042 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
8043 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
8044 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
8045 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
8047 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
8048 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
8049 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
8050 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
8051 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
8052 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
8053 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
8054 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
8056 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
8057 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
8058 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
8059 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
8060 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
8061 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
8062 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
8063 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
8064 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
8065 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
8066 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
8067 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
8068 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
8070 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
8071 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
8072 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
8073 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
8074 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
8075 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
8076 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
8077 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
8078 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
8079 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
8080 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
8081 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
8083 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
8084 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
8085 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
8086 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
8087 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
8089 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
8090 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
8091 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
8092 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
8093 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
8094 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
8096 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
8097 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
8098 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
8099 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
8100 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
8101 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
8102 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
8103 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
8104 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
8105 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
8106 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
8107 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
8109 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
8110 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
8112 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
8113 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
8114 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
8115 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
8116 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
8117 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
8119 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
8120 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
8121 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
8123 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
8124 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
8125 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
8126 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
8127 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
8128 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
8129 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
8130 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
8131 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
8132 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
8133 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
8134 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
8136 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
8137 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
8139 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
8140 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
8141 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
8142 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
8143 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
8144 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
8145 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
8146 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
8148 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
8149 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
8150 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
8151 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
8152 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
8153 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
8154 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
8155 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
8156 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
8157 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
8158 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
8159 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
8161 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
8162 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
8163 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
8164 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
8165 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
8166 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
8167 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
8168 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
8169 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
8170 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
8172 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
8173 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
8174 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
8175 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
8176 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
8177 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
8178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
8179 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
8180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
8181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
8183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
8184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
8185 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
8186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
8187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
8188 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
8189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
8190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
8191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
8192 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
8194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
8195 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
8196 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
8197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
8199 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
8200 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
8201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
8202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
8203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
8204 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
8205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
8206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
8207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
8208 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
8209 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
8210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
8211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
8212 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
8213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
8214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
8216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
8217 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
8218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
8219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
8220 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
8221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
8222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
8223 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
8224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
8225 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
8227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
8228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
8230 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
8231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
8232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
8233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
8235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
8236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
8237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
8238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
8240 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
8241 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
8243 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
8244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
8245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
8247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
8248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
8250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
8251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
8252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
8253 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
8254 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
8256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
8257 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
8259 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
8260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
8261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
8262 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
8265 % US-ASCII character definitions.
8266 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
8267 \relax
8270 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
8271 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
8272 % document encoding.
8274 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
8277 \message{formatting,}
8279 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
8281 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
8282 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
8283 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
8285 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
8286 \vbadness = 10000
8288 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
8289 \hbadness = 2000
8291 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
8292 \widowpenalty=10000
8293 \clubpenalty=10000
8295 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
8296 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
8297 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
8298 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
8300 \def\setemergencystretch{%
8301 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
8302 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
8303 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
8304 \else
8305 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
8309 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
8310 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
8311 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
8313 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
8314 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
8316 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
8317 \voffset = #3\relax
8318 \topskip = #6\relax
8319 \splittopskip = \topskip
8321 \vsize = #1\relax
8322 \advance\vsize by \topskip
8323 \outervsize = \vsize
8324 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
8325 \pageheight = \vsize
8327 \hsize = #2\relax
8328 \outerhsize = \hsize
8329 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
8330 \pagewidth = \hsize
8332 \normaloffset = #4\relax
8333 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
8335 \ifpdf
8336 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
8337 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
8338 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
8339 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
8342 \setleading{\textleading}
8344 \parindent = \defaultparindent
8345 \setemergencystretch
8348 % @letterpaper (the default).
8349 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8350 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8351 \textleading = 13.2pt
8353 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
8354 \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}%
8355 {\voffset}{.25in}%
8356 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
8357 {11in}{8.5in}%
8360 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
8361 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
8362 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
8363 \textleading = 12pt
8365 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
8366 {-.2in}{0in}%
8367 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
8368 {9.25in}{7in}%
8370 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
8371 \tolerance = 700
8372 \hfuzz = 1pt
8373 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8374 \defbodyindent = .5cm
8377 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
8378 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
8379 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
8380 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
8381 \textleading = 12pt
8383 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
8384 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
8385 {0pt}{14pt}%
8386 {9in}{6in}%
8388 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
8389 \tolerance = 700
8390 \hfuzz = 1pt
8391 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8392 \defbodyindent = .4cm
8395 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
8396 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8397 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8398 \textleading = 13.2pt
8400 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
8401 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
8402 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
8403 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
8404 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
8405 % your texinfo source file like this:
8406 % @tex
8407 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
8408 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
8409 % @end tex
8410 \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm}
8411 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8412 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
8413 {297mm}{210mm}%
8415 \tolerance = 700
8416 \hfuzz = 1pt
8417 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8418 \defbodyindent = 5mm
8421 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
8422 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
8423 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
8424 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8425 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
8426 \textleading = 12.5pt
8428 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
8429 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8430 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
8431 {210mm}{148mm}%
8433 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
8434 \tolerance = 800
8435 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
8436 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8437 \defbodyindent = 2mm
8438 \tableindent = 12mm
8441 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
8442 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
8443 \afourpaper
8444 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
8445 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
8446 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
8447 {297mm}{210mm}%
8449 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
8450 \globaldefs = 0
8453 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
8454 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
8455 \afourpaper
8456 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
8457 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
8458 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
8459 {297mm}{210mm}%
8460 \globaldefs = 0
8463 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
8464 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
8465 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
8467 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
8468 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
8469 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
8470 \globaldefs = 1
8472 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8473 \setleading{\textleading}%
8475 \dimen0 = #1
8476 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
8478 \dimen2 = \hsize
8479 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
8481 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
8482 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
8483 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
8484 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
8487 % Set default to letter.
8489 \letterpaper
8492 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
8494 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
8495 \catcode`\"=\other
8496 \catcode`\~=\other
8497 \catcode`\^=\other
8498 \catcode`\_=\other
8499 \catcode`\|=\other
8500 \catcode`\<=\other
8501 \catcode`\>=\other
8502 \catcode`\+=\other
8503 \catcode`\$=\other
8504 \def\normaldoublequote{"}
8505 \def\normaltilde{~}
8506 \def\normalcaret{^}
8507 \def\normalunderscore{_}
8508 \def\normalverticalbar{|}
8509 \def\normalless{<}
8510 \def\normalgreater{>}
8511 \def\normalplus{+}
8512 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
8514 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
8515 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
8516 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
8518 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
8519 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
8520 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
8521 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
8523 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
8525 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
8526 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
8527 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
8528 % this is not a problem.
8529 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
8531 % Turn off all special characters except @
8532 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
8533 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
8534 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
8536 \catcode`\"=\active
8537 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
8538 \let"=\activedoublequote
8539 \catcode`\~=\active
8540 \def~{{\tt\char126}}
8541 \chardef\hat=`\^
8542 \catcode`\^=\active
8543 \def^{{\tt \hat}}
8545 \catcode`\_=\active
8546 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
8547 \let\realunder=_
8548 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
8549 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
8551 \catcode`\|=\active
8552 \def|{{\tt\char124}}
8553 \chardef \less=`\<
8554 \catcode`\<=\active
8555 \def<{{\tt \less}}
8556 \chardef \gtr=`\>
8557 \catcode`\>=\active
8558 \def>{{\tt \gtr}}
8559 \catcode`\+=\active
8560 \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
8561 \catcode`\$=\active
8562 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
8564 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
8565 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
8566 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
8567 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
8568 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
8570 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
8571 % parsing them.
8572 \def\turnoffactive{%
8573 \normalturnoffactive
8574 \otherbackslash
8577 \catcode`\@=0
8579 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
8580 % as in \char`\\.
8581 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
8582 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
8584 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
8585 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
8586 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
8588 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
8589 % in fixed width font.
8590 \catcode`\\=\active
8591 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
8592 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
8593 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
8595 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
8596 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
8597 % catcode other.
8598 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
8599 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
8601 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
8602 % the literal character `\'.
8604 @def@normalturnoffactive{%
8605 @let\=@normalbackslash
8606 @let"=@normaldoublequote
8607 @let~=@normaltilde
8608 @let^=@normalcaret
8609 @let_=@normalunderscore
8610 @let|=@normalverticalbar
8611 @let<=@normalless
8612 @let>=@normalgreater
8613 @let+=@normalplus
8614 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
8615 @unsepspaces
8618 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
8619 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
8620 @otherifyactive
8622 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
8623 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
8624 % a backslash.
8626 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
8627 @global@let\ = @eatinput
8629 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
8630 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
8631 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
8632 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
8633 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
8635 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
8636 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
8637 @catcode`+=@active
8638 @catcode`@_=@active
8641 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
8642 @escapechar = `@@
8644 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
8645 @catcode`@& = @other
8646 @catcode`@# = @other
8647 @catcode`@% = @other
8650 @c Local variables:
8651 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
8652 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
8653 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
8654 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
8655 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
8656 @c End:
8658 @c vim:sw=2:
8660 @ignore
8661 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
8662 @end ignore